blob: 5b6ab44afc9982bdc6aaba71d816ebce1a5dbfd4 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01007 2018/12/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100903 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100905 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
906 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
907 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
908
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100909 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
910 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
911 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
912 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200915 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
916 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
917 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
918 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
919 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
920 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200922 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100924log-send-hostname [<string>]
925 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
926 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
927 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
928 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
929 the logs.
930
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931log-tag <string>
932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
933 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
934 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100935 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100937lua-load <file>
938 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
939 used multiple times.
940
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100941master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200942 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
943 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
944 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200946 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
947 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
949 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
950 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
951 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
952 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956nbproc <number>
957 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
958 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
959 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
960 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
961 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
962
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200963nbthread <number>
964 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
965 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
966 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
967 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
968 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
969
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
973 starting the process. See also "daemon".
974
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100975presetenv <name> <value>
976 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
977 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
978 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
979 and "unsetenv".
980
981resetenv [<name> ...]
982 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
983 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
984 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
985 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
986 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
987 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
988 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
989 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
990
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100991stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200992 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
993 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
994 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
995 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
996 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
997 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100998 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100999 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1000 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1001 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1002 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001003
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001004server-state-base <directory>
1005 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001006 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1007 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001008
1009server-state-file <file>
1010 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1011 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1012 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1013 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1014 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1015 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1016 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1017 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001018 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1019 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001020
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001021setenv <name> <value>
1022 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1023 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1024 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1025 and "unsetenv".
1026
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001027ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1029 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001030 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 for all
1031 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
1032 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance
1033 a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). For
1034 TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites"
1035 keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1036
1037ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1039 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1040 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1041 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1042 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1043 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites", and can
1044 be for instance a string such as
1045 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
1046 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
1047 the "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
1048 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001049
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001050ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1052 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1053 keyword to see available options.
1054
1055 Example:
1056 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001057 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001058
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001059ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1061 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001062 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 with the server,
1063 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
1064 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration,
1065 please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the
1066 "server" keyword for more information.
1067
1068ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1069 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1070 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1071 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1072 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1073 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1074 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration for
1075 TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword.
1076 Please check the "server" keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001077
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001078ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1080 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1081 keyword to see available options.
1082
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001083ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1085 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1086 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001087 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001088 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001089 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1090 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1091 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1092 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001093 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1094 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1095 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1096
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001097ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1098 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1099 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1100 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1101
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001102stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1103 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1104 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1105 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001106 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001107 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001108
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001109 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1110 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1111 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001112
1113stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1114 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1115 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001116 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001117
1118stats maxconn <connections>
1119 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1120 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122uid <number>
1123 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1124 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1125 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1126 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1127
1128ulimit-n <number>
1129 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1130 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1131 option.
1132
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001133unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1134 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1135
1136 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1137 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1138 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1139 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1140 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1141 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1142 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1143 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1144 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1145 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1146
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001147unsetenv [<name> ...]
1148 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1149 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1150 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1151 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1152 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1153 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1154 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1155
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001156user <user name>
1157 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1158 See also "uid" and "group".
1159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001160node <name>
1161 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1162
1163 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1164 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1165 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1166 traffic.
1167
1168description <text>
1169 Add a text that describes the instance.
1170
1171 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1172 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1173 "<" and ">" characters.
1174
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100117551degrees-data-file <file path>
1176 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001178
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001179 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001180 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1181
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000118251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001183 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1184 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1185 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1186
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001187 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001188 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1189
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200119051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001191 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1192 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1193
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001194 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1195 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1196
119751degrees-cache-size <number>
1198 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1199 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1200 By default, this cache is disabled.
1201
1202 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001203 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1204
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001205wurfl-data-file <file path>
1206 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1207 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1208
1209 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1210 with USE_WURFL=1.
1211
1212wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1213 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1214 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1215 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1216
1217 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1218
1219 Valid WURFL properties are:
1220 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1221
1222 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1223 device.
1224
1225 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1226 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1227
1228 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1229 particular web request.
1230
1231 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1232 used Libwurfl API version.
1233
1234 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1235 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1236 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1237
1238 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1239 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1240
1241 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1242 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1243
1244 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1245
1246 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1247
1248 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1249 with USE_WURFL=1.
1250
1251wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1252 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1253 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1254
1255 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1256 with USE_WURFL=1.
1257
1258wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1259 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1260 thus before the chroot.
1261
1262 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1263 with USE_WURFL=1.
1264
1265wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1266 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1267 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001268 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001269 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001270 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001271 mode is enabled by default.
1272
1273 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1274 with USE_WURFL=1.
1275
1276wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1277 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1278 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1279 - "0" : no cache is used.
1280 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1281 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1282 the highest performing option.
1283
1284 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1285 with USE_WURFL=1.
1286
1287wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1288 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1289 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1290
1291 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1292 with USE_WURFL=1.
1293
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012953.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001296-----------------------
1297
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001298busy-polling
1299 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1300 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1301 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1302 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1303 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1304 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1305 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1306 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1307 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1308 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1309 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1310 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1311 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1312 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1313 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1314 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1315 "poll" pollers.
1316
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001317max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1318 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1319 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1320 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1321 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1322 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1323 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1324 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1325 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1326
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327maxconn <number>
1328 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1329 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1330 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001331 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1332 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1333 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1334 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001335 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1336 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1337 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1338 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1339 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001340
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001341maxconnrate <number>
1342 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1343 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1344 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1345 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1346 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1347 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1348 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1349 fairness.
1350
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001351maxcomprate <number>
1352 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001353 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001354 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1355 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1356 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001357 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001358 default value.
1359
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001360maxcompcpuusage <number>
1361 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1362 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1363 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1364 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1365 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1366 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1367 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1368 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1369
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001370maxpipes <number>
1371 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1372 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1373 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1374 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1375 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1376 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1377
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001378maxsessrate <number>
1379 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1380 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1381 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1382 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1383 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1384 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1385 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1386 fairness.
1387
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001388maxsslconn <number>
1389 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1390 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1391 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1392 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1393 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1394 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1395 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001396 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1397 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1398 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1399 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1400 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1401 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1402 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001403
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001404maxsslrate <number>
1405 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1406 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1407 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1408 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1409 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1410 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1411 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1412 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1413 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1414 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1415
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001416maxzlibmem <number>
1417 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1418 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1419 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001420 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1421 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1422 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1423
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001424noepoll
1425 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1426 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001427 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428
1429nokqueue
1430 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1431 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1432 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1433
1434nopoll
1435 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1436 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001438 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001440nosplice
1441 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001442 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001443 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001444 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001445 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1446 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1447 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1448 "option splice-response".
1449
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001450nogetaddrinfo
1451 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1452 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1453
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001454noreuseport
1455 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1456 command line argument "-dR".
1457
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001458profiling.tasks { on | off }
1459 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1460 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1461 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1462 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1463 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1464 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1465 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1466 CLI.
1467
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001468spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001469 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1470 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1471 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1472 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1473 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1474 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001476ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001477 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001478 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001479 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1480 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1481 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1482 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1483 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1485 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001486 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1487 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1488 openssl configuration file uses:
1489 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1490
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001491ssl-mode-async
1492 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001493 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001494 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1495 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1496 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1497 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1498 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001499
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001500tune.buffers.limit <number>
1501 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1502 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1503 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1504 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1505 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001507 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1508 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1509 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1510 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1511 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1512 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1513 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1514 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1515 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1516
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001517tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1518 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1519 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1520 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1521 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1522
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001523tune.bufsize <number>
1524 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1525 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1526 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1527 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1528 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1529 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1530 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001531 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1532 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1533 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001534 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001535 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1536 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1537 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001538
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001539tune.chksize <number>
1540 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1541 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1542 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1543 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1544 checks whenever possible.
1545
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001546tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1547 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1548 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1549 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1550 this value. The default value is 1.
1551
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001552tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1553 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1554 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1555 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1556 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1557 change it.
1558
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001559tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1560 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001561 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1562 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001563 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1564 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1565 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1566 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1567 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1568
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001569tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1570 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1571 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1572 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1573 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1574 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1575 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1576 recommended not to change this value.
1577
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001578tune.http.cookielen <number>
1579 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1580 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1581 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1582 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1583 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1584 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1585 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1586 to change this value.
1587
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001588tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001589 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1590 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001591 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001592 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001593 configuration directives too.
1594 The default value is 1024.
1595
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001596tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1597 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1598 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1599 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1600 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1601 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1602 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001603 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1604 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1605 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001606
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001607tune.idletimer <timeout>
1608 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1609 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1610 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1611 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1612 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1613 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001614 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001615 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1616 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1617
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001618tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1619 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001620 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001621 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1622 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001623 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001624 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1625 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1626
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001627tune.lua.maxmem
1628 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1629 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1630 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1631 memory.
1632
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001633tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1634 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001635 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1636 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001637 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001638
1639tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1640 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1641 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1642 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1643 check servers.
1644
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001645tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1646 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1647 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1648 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001649 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001650
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001651tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001652 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1653 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1654 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1655 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1656 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1657 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1658 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1659 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1660 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1661 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001662
1663tune.maxpollevents <number>
1664 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1665 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1666 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1667 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1668 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1669
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001670tune.maxrewrite <number>
1671 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1672 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1673 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1674 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1675 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1676 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1677 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1678 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1679 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1680 bufsize.
1681
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001682tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1683 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1684 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1685 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1686 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1687 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1688 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1689 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1690 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1691 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1692 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1693 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1694 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1695 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1696 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1697 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1698 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1699 setting this parameter to 0.
1700
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001701tune.pipesize <number>
1702 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1703 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1704 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1705 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1706 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1707 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1708
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001709tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1710tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1711 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1712 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1713 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1714 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001715 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001716 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1717 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1718
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001719tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001720 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001721 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1722 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1723 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1724 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1725
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001726tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1727 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1728 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1729 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1730
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001731tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1732tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1733 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1734 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1735 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1736 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001737 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001738 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1739 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1740 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1741 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1742 notifying haproxy again.
1743
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001744tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001745 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1746 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1747 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001748 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001749 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001750 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001751 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1752 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1753 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001754 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1755 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001756
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001757tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001758 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001759 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1760 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1761 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1762 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1763 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1764
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001765tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1766 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001767 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001768 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1769 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1770 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1771 being used for too long.
1772
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001773tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1774 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1775 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1776 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1777 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1778 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1779 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1780 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1781 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1782 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1783 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001784 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001785 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001786
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001787tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1788 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1789 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1790 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1791 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1792 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1793 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1794 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001795 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1796 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001797
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001798tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1799 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1800 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1801 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1802 1000 entries.
1803
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001804tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1805 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1806 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1807 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1808
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001809tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001810tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001811tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1812tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1813tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001814 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1815 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1816 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1817 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1818 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1819 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1820 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1821 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001822
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001823 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1824 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1825 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1826 all available space is consumed.
1827 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1828 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1829 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001830
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001831tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1832 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001833 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001834 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001835 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001836 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1837
1838tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1839 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1840 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001841 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1842 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018443.3. Debugging
1845--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001846
1847debug
1848 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1849 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1850 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1851 system startup.
1852
1853quiet
1854 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1855 line argument "-q".
1856
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018583.4. Userlists
1859--------------
1860It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1861http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1862it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1863
1864userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001865 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001866 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1867
1868group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001869 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001870 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1871 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1872
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001873user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1874 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001875 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1876 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001877 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1878 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1879 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1880 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001881
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001882 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1883 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1884 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1885 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1886 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1887 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1888 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1889 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1890 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001891
1892 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001893 userlist L1
1894 group G1 users tiger,scott
1895 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001896
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001897 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1898 user scott insecure-password elgato
1899 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001900
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001901 userlist L2
1902 group G1
1903 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001905 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1906 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1907 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001908
1909 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001910
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001911
19123.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001913----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001914It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1915several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1916instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1917values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1918automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1919In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1920using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1921tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1922reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1923Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1924that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1925each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001926
1927peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001928 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001929 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1930
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001931disabled
1932 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1933 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1934 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1935
1936enable
1937 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1938
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001939peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1940 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1941 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1942 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1943 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1944 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1945 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1946
1947 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1948 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1949
1950 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1951 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1952 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1953 across all peers.
1954
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001955 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1956 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001957
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001958 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001959 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001960 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1961 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1962 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001963
1964 backend mybackend
1965 mode tcp
1966 balance roundrobin
1967 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1968 stick on src
1969
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001970 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1971 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001972
1973
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090019743.6. Mailers
1975------------
1976It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1977If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1978in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1979
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001980mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001981 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1982 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1983
1984mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1985 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1986
1987 Example:
1988 mailers mymailers
1989 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1990 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1991
1992 backend mybackend
1993 mode tcp
1994 balance roundrobin
1995
1996 email-alert mailers mymailers
1997 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1998 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1999
2000 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2001 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2002
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002003timeout mail <time>
2004 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2005 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2006 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2007 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2008
2009 Example:
2010 mailers mymailers
2011 timeout mail 20s
2012 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020144. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002015----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002017Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002018 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002019 - frontend <name>
2020 - backend <name>
2021 - listen <name>
2022
2023A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2024its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2025section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002027
2028A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2029connections.
2030
2031A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2032to forward incoming connections.
2033
2034A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2035parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2036
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002037All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2038'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2039case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2040
2041Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2042logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2043proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2044However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2045name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2046
2047Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2048and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002049bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002050protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2051modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2052arbitrary criteria.
2053
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002054In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2055a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002056the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002057
2058 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2059 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2060 between responses and new requests.
2061
2062 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2063 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2064 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002065 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2066 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002067
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002068 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2069 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2070 client-facing connection remains open.
2071
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002072 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2073 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002074
2075The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2076frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2077following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002078weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002079
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002080 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002081
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002082 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2083 ----+-----+-----+----
2084 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2085 ----+-----+-----+----
2086 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2087 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2088 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2089 ----+-----+-----+----
2090 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002091
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020944.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2095--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002097The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2098limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2099they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2100limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002101marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002102option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002103and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2104with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2105specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002106
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002107
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002108 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2109------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2110acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002111appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002112backlog X X X -
2113balance X - X X
2114bind - X X -
2115bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002116block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002117capture cookie - X X -
2118capture request header - X X -
2119capture response header - X X -
2120clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002121compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002122contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2123cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002124declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002125default-server X - X X
2126default_backend X X X -
2127description - X X X
2128disabled X X X X
2129dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002130email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002131email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002132email-alert mailers X X X X
2133email-alert myhostname X X X X
2134email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002135enabled X X X X
2136errorfile X X X X
2137errorloc X X X X
2138errorloc302 X X X X
2139-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2140errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002141force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002142filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002143fullconn X - X X
2144grace X X X X
2145hash-type X - X X
2146http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002147http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002148http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002149http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002150http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002151http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002152http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002153id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002154ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002155load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002156log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002157log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002158log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002159log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002160max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002161maxconn X X X -
2162mode X X X X
2163monitor fail - X X -
2164monitor-net X X X -
2165monitor-uri X X X -
2166option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2167option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2168option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2169option allbackups (*) X - X X
2170option checkcache (*) X - X X
2171option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2172option contstats (*) X X X -
2173option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2174option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002175option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002176-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2177option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002178option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002179option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002180option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002181option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002182option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002183option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002184option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002185option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002186option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002187option httpchk X - X X
2188option httpclose (*) X X X X
2189option httplog X X X X
2190option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002191option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002192option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002193option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002194option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2195option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2196option logasap (*) X X X -
2197option mysql-check X - X X
2198option nolinger (*) X X X X
2199option originalto X X X X
2200option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002201option pgsql-check X - X X
2202option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002203option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002204option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002205option smtpchk X - X X
2206option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2207option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2208option splice-request (*) X X X X
2209option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002210option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002211option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2212option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2213-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002214option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002215option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2216option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2217option tcpka X X X X
2218option tcplog X X X X
2219option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002220external-check command X - X X
2221external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002222persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2223rate-limit sessions X X X -
2224redirect - X X X
2225redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2226redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2227reqadd - X X X
2228reqallow - X X X
2229reqdel - X X X
2230reqdeny - X X X
2231reqiallow - X X X
2232reqidel - X X X
2233reqideny - X X X
2234reqipass - X X X
2235reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002236reqitarpit - X X X
2237reqpass - X X X
2238reqrep - X X X
2239-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002240reqtarpit - X X X
2241retries X - X X
2242rspadd - X X X
2243rspdel - X X X
2244rspdeny - X X X
2245rspidel - X X X
2246rspideny - X X X
2247rspirep - X X X
2248rsprep - X X X
2249server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002250server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002251server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002252source X - X X
2253srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002254stats admin - X X X
2255stats auth X X X X
2256stats enable X X X X
2257stats hide-version X X X X
2258stats http-request - X X X
2259stats realm X X X X
2260stats refresh X X X X
2261stats scope X X X X
2262stats show-desc X X X X
2263stats show-legends X X X X
2264stats show-node X X X X
2265stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002266-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2267stick match - - X X
2268stick on - - X X
2269stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002270stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002271stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002272tcp-check connect - - X X
2273tcp-check expect - - X X
2274tcp-check send - - X X
2275tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002276tcp-request connection - X X -
2277tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002278tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002279tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002280tcp-response content - - X X
2281tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002282timeout check X - X X
2283timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002284timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002285timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2286timeout connect X - X X
2287timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2288timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2289timeout http-request X X X X
2290timeout queue X - X X
2291timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002292timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002293timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2294timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002295timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002296transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002297unique-id-format X X X -
2298unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002299use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002300use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002301------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2302 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023054.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2306---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307
2308This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2309
2310
2311acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2312 Declare or complete an access list.
2313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2314 no | yes | yes | yes
2315 Example:
2316 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2317 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2318 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002320 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321
2322
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002323appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2324 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002325 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2327 no | no | yes | yes
2328 Arguments :
2329 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2330 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2331
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002332 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333 checked in each cookie value.
2334
2335 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2336 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2337 milliseconds.
2338
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002339 request-learn
2340 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2341 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2342 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2343 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2344 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2345 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2346
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002347 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2348 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2349 data following this prefix.
2350
2351 Example :
2352 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002354 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2355 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002356
2357 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2358 2 modes are currently supported :
2359 - path-parameters :
2360 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2361 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2362 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2363 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2364 - query-string :
2365 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2366 query string.
2367
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002368 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2369 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2370 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002371
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002372 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2373 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374
2375
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002376backlog <conns>
2377 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2379 yes | yes | yes | no
2380 Arguments :
2381 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2382 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002383 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002384
2385 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2386 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2387 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2388 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2389 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2390 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2391 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2392 backlog parameter.
2393
2394 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2395 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2396 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2397
2398 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2399
2400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002402balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002403 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2405 yes | no | yes | yes
2406 Arguments :
2407 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2408 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2409 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2410 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2411
2412 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2413 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2414 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2415 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002416 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002417 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002418 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2419 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2420 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2421 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2422 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2423 it, so that you don't worry.
2424
2425 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2426 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2427 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2428 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2429 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2430 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2431 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2432 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002434 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2435 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2436 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2437 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2438 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2439 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2440 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2441 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2442
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002443 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002444 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002445 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2446 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002447 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002448 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2449 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2450 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2451 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2452 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002453 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2454 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2455 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2456 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2457 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2458 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002460 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2461 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2462 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2463 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2464 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2465 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2466 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2467 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002468 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002469 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002470 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2471 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2472 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002474 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2475 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2476 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2477 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2478 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2479 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2480 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2481 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2482 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2483 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2484 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2485 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002486
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002487 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002488 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2489 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2490 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2491 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2492 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2493 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2494 URIs start with a leading "/".
2495
2496 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2497 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2498 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2499 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2500
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002501 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002502 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2503
2504 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002505 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2506 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002507 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2508 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2509 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2510 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002511 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002512 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2513 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002514
2515 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2516 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2517 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2518 server will receive the request.
2519
2520 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2521 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2522 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2523 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2524 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002525 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2526 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2527 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002528
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002529 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2530 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2531 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2532 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2533 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002535 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002536 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2537 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2538 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2539
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002540 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2541 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2542 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2543
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002544 random
2545 random(<draws>)
2546 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002547 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2548 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2549 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2550 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002551 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2552 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2553 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2554 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2555 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2556 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2557 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2558 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2559 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2560 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2561 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2562 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2563 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2564 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2565 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2566 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2567 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2568 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2569 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2570 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002571
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002572 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002573 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002574 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2575 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2576 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2577 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2578 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2579 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002580 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002581 used instead.
2582
2583 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2584 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2585 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2586 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2587
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002588 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2589 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2590 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2591
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002592 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002593
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002594 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002595 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2596 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002597
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002598 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2599 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2600 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002602 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2603 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2604 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2605 NTLM relies on.
2606
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607 Examples :
2608 balance roundrobin
2609 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002610 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002611 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2612 balance hdr(host)
2613 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002614
2615 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2616 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2617
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002618 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002619 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2620 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2621 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2622 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2623
2624 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2625 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2626 defaults to 16 kB.
2627
2628 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2629 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2630
2631 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2632 Round Robin.
2633
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002634 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002635 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2636 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2637 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2638
2639 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2640
2641 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002642 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002643 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2644 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2645 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002647 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002648
2649
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002650bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2651bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002652 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2654 no | yes | yes | no
2655 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002656 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2657 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2658 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2659 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002660 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002661 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2662 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2663 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2664 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2665 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2666 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2667 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002668 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2669 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2670 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2671 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2672 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2673 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2674 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002675 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2676 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2677 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002678 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2679 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2680 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2681 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002682 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2683 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2684 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002685
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002686 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2687 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002688 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2689 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2690 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002691 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2692 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2693 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2694 the range.
2695
2696 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2697 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2698 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2699 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2700 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2701 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2702 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002703 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002704 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002705
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002706 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002707 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002708 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2709 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2710 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2711 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2712 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2713 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2714
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002715 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2716 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2717 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2718 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002719
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2721 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2722 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2723 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2724 in a frontend.
2725
2726 Example :
2727 listen http_proxy
2728 bind :80,:443
2729 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002730 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002731
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002732 listen http_https_proxy
2733 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002734 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002735
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002736 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2737 bind ipv6@:80
2738 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2739 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2740
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002741 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002742 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002743
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002744 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2745 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2746 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2747 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2748 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2749
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002750 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002751 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002752
2753
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002754bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002755 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2757 yes | yes | yes | yes
2758 Arguments :
2759 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2760 may be used to override a default value.
2761
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002762 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002763 option may be combined with other numbers.
2764
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002765 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002766 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2767 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2768 missing from all processes.
2769
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002770 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002771 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002772 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2773 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2774 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2775 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2776 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002777 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002778
2779 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2780 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2781 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2782 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2783 and 'even' instances.
2784
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002785 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2786 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2787 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2788 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002789
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002790 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2791 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2792
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002793 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2794 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2795 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2796
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002797 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2798 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2799
2800 Example :
2801 listen app_ip1
2802 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002803 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002804
2805 listen app_ip2
2806 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002807 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002808
2809 listen management
2810 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002811 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002812
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002813 listen management
2814 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2815 bind-process 1-4
2816
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002817 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002818
2819
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002820block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2823 no | yes | yes | yes
2824
2825 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2826 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002827 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002828 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002829 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002830 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2831 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2832 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002833
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002834 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2835 "http-request deny" instead.
2836
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002837 Example:
2838 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2839 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2840 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002841 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2842 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2843 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002844
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002845 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2846 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2847 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848
2849capture cookie <name> len <length>
2850 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2852 no | yes | yes | no
2853 Arguments :
2854 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2855 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2856 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2857 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002858 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859
2860 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2861 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2862 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2863 right if it exceeds <length>.
2864
2865 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2866 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2867 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2868 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2869
2870 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2871 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2872 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2873
2874 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2875 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2876 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002877 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2878 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2879 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880
2881 Example:
2882 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2883
2884 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002885 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886
2887
2888capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002889 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2891 no | yes | yes | no
2892 Arguments :
2893 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002894 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002895 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2896 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2897 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2898
2899 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2900 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2901 it exceeds <length>.
2902
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002903 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002904 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2905 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002906 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2907 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2908 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2909 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002910 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002911 environments to find where the request came from.
2912
2913 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2914 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2915 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2916 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002918 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2919 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2920 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2921 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2922 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002923
2924 Example:
2925 capture request header Host len 15
2926 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002927 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002929 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002930 about logging.
2931
2932
2933capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002934 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2936 no | yes | yes | no
2937 Arguments :
2938 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002939 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002940 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2941 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2942 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2943
2944 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2945 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2946 it exceeds <length>.
2947
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002948 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002949 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2950 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2951 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002952 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2953 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2954 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2955 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002956
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002957 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2958 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2959 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2960 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2961 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962
2963 Example:
2964 capture response header Content-length len 9
2965 capture response header Location len 15
2966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002967 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002968 about logging.
2969
2970
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002971clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002972 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2974 yes | yes | yes | no
2975 Arguments :
2976 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2977 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2978 as explained at the top of this document.
2979
2980 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2981 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2982 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2983 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2984 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2985 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2986 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2987 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002988 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002989 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002990 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002991
2992 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2993 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2994 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2995 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2996 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2997 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2998
2999 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3000 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3001
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003002 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3003 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003004
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003005compression algo <algorithm> ...
3006compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003007compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003008 Enable HTTP compression.
3009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3010 yes | yes | yes | yes
3011 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003012 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3013 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3014 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3015
3016 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003017 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3018 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3019 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003020
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003021 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003022 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003023
3024 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3025 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3026 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3027 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3028 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003029 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003030
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003031 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3032 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3033 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3034 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3035 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3036 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3037 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003038 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003039
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003040 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003041 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003042 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3043 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3044 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3045 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3046 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003047
3048 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3049 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3050 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3051 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3052 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003053 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3054 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3055 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3056 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3057 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003058 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3059 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003060
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003061 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003062 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3063 "Accept-Encoding" header
3064 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01003065 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01003066 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
3067 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003068 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3069 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3070 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3071 "multipart"
3072 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3073 header
3074 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3075 and later
3076 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3077 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003078
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003079 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
3080 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003081
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003082 Examples :
3083 compression algo gzip
3084 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003086
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003087contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003088 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3090 yes | no | yes | yes
3091 Arguments :
3092 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3093 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3094 as explained at the top of this document.
3095
3096 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003097 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003098 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003099 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003100 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3101 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3102 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3103
3104 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3105 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3106 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3107 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3108 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3109 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3110
3111 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3112 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3113 instead.
3114
3115 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3116 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3117
3118
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003119cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003120 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3121 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003122 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003123 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3125 yes | no | yes | yes
3126 Arguments :
3127 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3128 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3129 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3130 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3131 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3132 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003133 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003134 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3135 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3136
3137 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3138 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3139 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3140 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3141 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3142 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003143 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3144 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003145 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003146 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3147 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148
3149 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003150 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003151
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003152 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003153 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3154 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003155 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003156 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3157 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3158 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3159 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3160 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3161 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3162 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003163
3164 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3165 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3166 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3167 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3168 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3169 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3170 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3171 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3172 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003173 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003174 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3175 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3176 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003177
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003178 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3179 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3180 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003181 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3182 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3183 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3184 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003185 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3186 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3187 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003188
3189 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3190 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3191 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3192 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3193 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3194 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3195 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3196 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3197 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3198
3199 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3200 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3201 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3202 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3203 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3204 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3205 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3206 persistence cookie in the cache.
3207 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3208
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003209 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3210 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3211 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3212 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3213 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003214 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003215 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3216 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3217 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3218 they logout.
3219
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003220 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3221 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3222 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3223 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3224
3225 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3226 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3227 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3228 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3229 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3230 this attribute.
3231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003232 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003233 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003234 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3235 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3236 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3237 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3238 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3239 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003240
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003241 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3242 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3243 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3244 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3245 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3246 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3247 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3248 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003249 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003250 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3251 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3252 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3253 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3254 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3255 the site.
3256
3257 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3258 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3259 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3260 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3261 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3262 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3263 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3264 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3265 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3266 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3267 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3268 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3269 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003270 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003271 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3272 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3273
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003274 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3275 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3276 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3277 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3278 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3279 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3280
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003281 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3282 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3283 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3284 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003285
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286 Examples :
3287 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3288 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3289 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003290 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003291
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003292 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003293
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003294
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003295declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3296 Declares a capture slot.
3297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3298 no | yes | yes | no
3299 Arguments:
3300 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3301
3302 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3303 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3304 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3305 for use in the response.
3306
3307 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003308 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003309 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3310
3311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003312default-server [param*]
3313 Change default options for a server in a backend
3314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3315 yes | no | yes | yes
3316 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003317 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3318 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3319 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3320 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003321
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003322 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003323 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3324
3325 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003326
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003327
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003328default_backend <backend>
3329 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3331 yes | yes | yes | no
3332 Arguments :
3333 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3334
3335 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3336 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3337 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3338 will catch all undetermined requests.
3339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003340 Example :
3341
3342 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3343 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3344 default_backend dynamic
3345
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003346 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003348
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003349description <string>
3350 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3352 no | yes | yes | yes
3353 Arguments : string
3354
3355 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3356 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3357 it describes.
3358 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3359
3360
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003361disabled
3362 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 yes | yes | yes | yes
3365 Arguments : none
3366
3367 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3368 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3369 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3370 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3371 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3372 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3373 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3374
3375 See also : "enabled"
3376
3377
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003378dispatch <address>:<port>
3379 Set a default server address
3380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3381 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003382 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003383
3384 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3385 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3386 during start-up.
3387
3388 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3389 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3390 possible with normal servers.
3391
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003392 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003393 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3394 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3395 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3396 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3397
3398 See also : "server"
3399
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003400
3401dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3402 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3404 yes | no | yes | yes
3405 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3406
3407 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003408 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003409 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3410 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003412 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003413
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003414enabled
3415 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3417 yes | yes | yes | yes
3418 Arguments : none
3419
3420 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3421 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3422
3423 See also : "disabled"
3424
3425
3426errorfile <code> <file>
3427 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3429 yes | yes | yes | yes
3430 Arguments :
3431 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003432 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3433 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003434
3435 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003436 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003437 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003438 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3439 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003440
3441 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3442 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3443 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3444
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003445 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003447 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3448 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3449 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3450 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3451
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003452 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3453 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003454 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003455 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3456 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3457 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3460 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3461 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003462 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3464
3465 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3466
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003467 Example :
3468 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003469 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003470 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3471 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3472
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003473
3474errorloc <code> <url>
3475errorloc302 <code> <url>
3476 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3478 yes | yes | yes | yes
3479 Arguments :
3480 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003481 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3482 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003483
3484 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3485 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3486 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3487 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003488 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003489
3490 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3491 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3492 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3493
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003494 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3495
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003496 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3497 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3498 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3499 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003500 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003501 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3502 request.
3503
3504 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3505
3506
3507errorloc303 <code> <url>
3508 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3510 yes | yes | yes | yes
3511 Arguments :
3512 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003513 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3514 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003515
3516 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3517 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3518 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3519 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003520 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003521
3522 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3523 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3524 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3525
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003526 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3527
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003528 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3529 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3530 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3531 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003532 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003533
3534 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3535
3536
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003537email-alert from <emailaddr>
3538 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003539 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003540 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3541 yes | yes | yes | yes
3542
3543 Arguments :
3544
3545 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3546
3547 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3548 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3549
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003550 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003551 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3552 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003553
3554
3555email-alert level <level>
3556 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3557 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3558 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3559 yes | yes | yes | yes
3560
3561 Arguments :
3562
3563 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3564 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3565 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3566
3567 By default level is alert
3568
3569 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3570 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3571 for the proxy.
3572
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003573 Alerts are sent when :
3574
3575 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3576 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3577 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3578 is notice or lower
3579 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3580 and a health check status update occurs
3581
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003582 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3583 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003584 section 3.6 about mailers.
3585
3586
3587email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3588 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3589 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3590 yes | yes | yes | yes
3591
3592 Arguments :
3593
3594 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3595
3596 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3597 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3598
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003599 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3600 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003601
3602
3603email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3604 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3605 mailers.
3606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3607 yes | yes | yes | yes
3608
3609 Arguments :
3610
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003611 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003612
3613 By default the systems hostname is used.
3614
3615 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3616 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3617 for the proxy.
3618
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003619 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3620 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003621
3622
3623email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003624 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003625 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3627 yes | yes | yes | yes
3628
3629 Arguments :
3630
3631 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3632
3633 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3634 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3635
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003636 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003637 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3638
3639
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003640force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3641 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3642 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003643 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003644
3645 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3646 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3647 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3648 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3649 marked down for maintenance operations.
3650
3651 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3652 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3653 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3654 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3655 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3656 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3657 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3658 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3659 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3660
3661 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3662 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3663 is used.
3664
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003665 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003666 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003667
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003668
3669filter <name> [param*]
3670 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3672 no | yes | yes | yes
3673 Arguments :
3674 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3675 referenced in section 9.
3676
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003677 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003678 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003679 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3680 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003681
3682 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3683 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3684
3685 Example:
3686 listen
3687 bind *:80
3688
3689 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3690 filter compression
3691 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3692
3693 compression algo gzip
3694 compression offload
3695
3696 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3697
3698 See also : section 9.
3699
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003701fullconn <conns>
3702 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3704 yes | no | yes | yes
3705 Arguments :
3706 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3707 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3708
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003709 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003710 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003711 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003712 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3713 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3714 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3715 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3716 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003717 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003718
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003719 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3720 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003721 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3722 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3723 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003724
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003725 Example :
3726 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3727 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3728 # connections.
3729 backend dynamic
3730 fullconn 10000
3731 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3732 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3733
3734 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3735
3736
3737grace <time>
3738 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003740 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003741 Arguments :
3742 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3743 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3744 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3745
3746 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3747 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003748 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003749 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3750
3751 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3752 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3753 simplify it.
3754
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003755
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003756hash-balance-factor <factor>
3757 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3759 yes | no | no | yes
3760 Arguments :
3761 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3762 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3763 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3764
3765 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3766 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3767 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3768 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3769 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3770 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3771 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3772
3773 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3774 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3775 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3776 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3777 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3778
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003779 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3780 consistent hashing mechanism.
3781
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003782 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3783
3784
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003785hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003786 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3788 yes | no | yes | yes
3789 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003790 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3791 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003792
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003793 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3794 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3795 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3796 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3797 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3798 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3799 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3800 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3801 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3802 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003803
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003804 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3805 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3806 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3807 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3808 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3809 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3810 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3811 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3812 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3813 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3814 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3815 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3816 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003817 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3818 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003819
3820 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3821
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003822 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003823 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3824 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3825 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003826 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3827 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3828 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003829
3830 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3831 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003832 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3833 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3834 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3835 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3836
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003837 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3838 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3839 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3840 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3841 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3842 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3843 parameter.
3844
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003845 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3846 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3847 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3848 used on strings.
3849
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003850 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3851
3852 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3853 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3854 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3855 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3856 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3857 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3858 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3859 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3860 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3861 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3862 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3863 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003864
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003865 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3866 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3867 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003868
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003869 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003870
3871
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003872http-check disable-on-404
3873 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003875 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003876 Arguments : none
3877
3878 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3879 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3880 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3881 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3882 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3883 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3884 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3885 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003886 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3887 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3888 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3889
3890 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3891
3892
3893http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003894 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003896 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003897 Arguments :
3898 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3899 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003900 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003901 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3902 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3903 details on the supported keywords.
3904
3905 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3906 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3907 with the usual backslash ('\').
3908
3909 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3910 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3911 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3912 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3913 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3914
3915 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003916 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003917 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3918 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3919 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3920
3921 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003922 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003923 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3924 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3925 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3926 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3927
3928 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003929 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003930 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3931 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3932 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3933 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3934 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003935 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003936 trace).
3937
3938 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003939 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003940 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3941 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3942 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3943 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3944 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003945 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003946
3947 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3948 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3949 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3950 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3951 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3952 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3953 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3954 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3955
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003956 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3957 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3958 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3959
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003960 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3961 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3962
3963 Examples :
3964 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003965 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003966
3967 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003968 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003969
3970 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003971 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003972
3973 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003974 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003975
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003976 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003977
3978
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003979http-check send-state
3980 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3982 yes | no | yes | yes
3983 Arguments : none
3984
3985 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3986 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3987 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3988 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3989 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3990
3991 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3992 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3993 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3994 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3995 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003996 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3997 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3998 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3999
4000 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4001 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4002 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4003
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004004 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4005 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4006 checked in multiple backends.
4007
4008 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4009 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4010
4011 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4012 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4013 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4014 one fails.
4015
4016 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4017 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4018 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4019
4020 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4021 server's queue.
4022
4023 Example of a header received by the application server :
4024 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4025 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4026
4027 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004029
4030http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004031 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4032
4033 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4034 no | yes | yes | yes
4035
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004036 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4037 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4038 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4039 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4040 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004042 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4043 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004045 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004047 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4048 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4049 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4050 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004052 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4053 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4054 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4055 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004057 Example:
4058 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4059 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4060 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004062 http-request allow if nagios
4063 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4064 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4065 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004067 Example:
4068 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4069 acl add path /addacl
4070 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004072 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004073
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004074 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4075 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004077 Example:
4078 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4079 acl setmap path /setmap
4080 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004082 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004084 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4085 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004087 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4088 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004090http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004092 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4093 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4094 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4095 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4096 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4097 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4098 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4099 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004101http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004103 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4104 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4105 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4106 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4107 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4108 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4109 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4110 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004112http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004114 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4115 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004116
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004118http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004120 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4121 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4122 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4123 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4124 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004126 Example:
4127 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4128 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004129
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004130http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004132 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004134http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4135 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004136
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004137 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4138 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4139 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4140 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4141 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4142 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4143 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4144 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4145 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004147 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4148 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4149 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4150 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4151 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4152 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004154http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004156 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4157 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4158 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4159 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4160 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4161 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004163http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004164
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004165 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004167http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004169 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4170 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4171 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4172 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4173 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4174 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004176http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004178 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4179 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4180 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4181 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4182 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004183
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004184http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4185
4186 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4187 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4188 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4189 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004190 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4191 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004192
4193 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004195http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004197 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4198 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4199 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4200 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4201 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004203http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4206 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4207 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4208 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004210http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4211 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004213 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4214 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4215 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4216 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4217 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4218 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4219 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4220 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004222 Example:
4223 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 # applied to:
4226 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004227
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004228 # outputs:
4229 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004231 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4234 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004236 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4237 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4238 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4239 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004241 Example:
4242 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004244 # applied to:
4245 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004247 # outputs:
4248 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004250http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4251http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004253 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4254 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4255 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004257http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4260 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4261 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004263http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004264
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004265 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4266 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4267 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4268 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4269 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004271 Arguments:
4272 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4273 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004275 Example:
4276 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4277 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4280 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4285 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4286 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004288 Arguments:
4289 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4290 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292 Example:
4293 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4294 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004296 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4297 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4298 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004300http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004301
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004302 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4303 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4304 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4305 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4306 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004308 Example:
4309 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4310 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4311 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4312 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4313 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4314 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4315 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4316 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4317 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004319http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4322 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4323 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4324 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4325 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4328 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4331 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4332 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4333 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4334 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4335 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4336 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4337 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4338 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4343 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4344 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4345 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4346 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4347 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4348 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004352 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4353 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4354 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004358 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4359 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4360 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4361 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4362 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4363 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4364 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4365 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4370 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4371 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4372 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4373 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4374 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376 Example :
4377 # prepend the host name before the path
4378 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004380http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004382 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4383 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4384 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4385 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4386 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004388http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004390 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4391 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4392 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4393 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4394 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4395 values have higher priority.
4396 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4397 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4398 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4399 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4400 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004402http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004404 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4405 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4406 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4407 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4408 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4409 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4410 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004412 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004413
4414 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004415 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4416 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4419 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4420 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4421 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4422 privacy.
4423
4424 Arguments :
4425 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4426 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004427
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004428 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4430 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4431
4432 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4433 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4434
4435http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4436
4437 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4438 expression.
4439
4440 Arguments:
4441 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4442 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004443
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004444 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4446 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4447
4448 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4449 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4450 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4451
4452http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4453
4454 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4455 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4456 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4457 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4458 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4459 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4460 information from the request.
4461
4462 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4463
4464http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4465
4466 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4467 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4468 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4469 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4470 path and the query string.
4471 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4472
4473http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4474
4475 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4476 inline.
4477
4478 Arguments:
4479 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4480 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4481 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4482 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4483 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4484 (request and response)
4485 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4486 processing
4487 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4488 processing
4489 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4490 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4491 and '_'.
4492
4493 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4494 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004495
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004496 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004497 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004499http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4500 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004502 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4503 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4504 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4505 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4506 agent name must be used.
4507
4508 Arguments:
4509 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4510
4511 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4512 configuration.
4513
4514http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4515
4516 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4517 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4518 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4519 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4520 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4521 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4522 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4523 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4524 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4525 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4526 action.
4527 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4528 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4529 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4530 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4531 you fully understand how it works.
4532
4533http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4534
4535 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4536 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4537 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4538 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4539 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4540 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4541 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4542 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4543 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4544 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4545 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4546 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4547 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4548
4549http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4550http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4551http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4552
4553 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4554 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4555 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4556 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4557 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4558 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4559 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4560 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4561 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4562 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4563 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4564 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4565
4566 Arguments :
4567 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4568 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4569 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4570 select which table entry to update the counters.
4571
4572 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4573 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4574 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4575 that table until the session ends.
4576
4577 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4578 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4579 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4580 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4581 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4582 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4583 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4584 useful information.
4585
4586 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4587 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4588 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4589 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4590 checks that make use of it.
4591
4592http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4593
4594 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004595
4596 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004597 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004599http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004601 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4602 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4603 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004604
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004605
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004606http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004607 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4608
4609 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4610 no | yes | yes | yes
4611
4612 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4613 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4614 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4615 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4616 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4617 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4618
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004619 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4620 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004621
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004622 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004623
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004624 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4625 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4626 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4627 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004628
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004629 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4630 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4631 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4632 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004633
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004634 Example:
4635 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004636
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004637 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004638
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004639 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4640 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004641
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004642 Example:
4643 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004644
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004645 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004646
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004647 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4648 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004649
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004650 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4651 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004652
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004653http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004654
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004655 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4656 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4657 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4658 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4659 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4660 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4661 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4662 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004664http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004666 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4667 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4668 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4669 example, or to pass some internal information.
4670 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4671 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4672 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004673
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004674http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004675
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004676 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4677 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004678
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004679http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004680
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004681 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004683http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004684
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004685 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4686 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4687 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4688 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4689 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4690 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4691 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004692
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004693 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4694 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4695 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4696 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4697 keyword.
4698 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4699 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004701http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004702
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004703 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4704 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4705 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4706 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4707 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4708 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004709
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004710http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004711
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004712 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004713
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004714http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004715
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004716 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4717 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4718 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4719 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4720 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4721 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004722
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004723http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004724
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004725 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4726 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004727
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004728http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004730 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4731 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4732 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4733 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4734 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4735 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004736
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004737http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4738 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004740 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4741 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4742 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4743 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4744 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4745 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4746 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4747 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004748
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004749 Example:
4750 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004752 # applied to:
4753 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004754
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004755 # outputs:
4756 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004757
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004758 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004759
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004760http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4761 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004762
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004763 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4764 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4765 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4766 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004767
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004768 Example:
4769 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004770
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004771 # applied to:
4772 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004773
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004774 # outputs:
4775 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004776
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004777http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4778http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004779
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004780 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4781 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4782 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004783
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004784http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004785
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004786 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4787 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4788 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004789
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004790http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004791
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004792 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4793 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4794 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4795 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4796 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004797
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004798 Arguments:
4799 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004800
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004801 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4802 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004803
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004804http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004805
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004806 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4807 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4808 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004809
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004810http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4811
4812 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4813 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4814 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4815 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4816 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4817
4818http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4819
4820 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4821 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4822 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4823 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4824 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4825 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4826 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4827 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4828 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4829
4830http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4831
4832 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4833 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4834 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4835 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4836 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4837 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4838 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4839
4840http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4841
4842 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4843 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4844 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4845 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4846 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4847 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4848 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4849 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4850
4851http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4852 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4853
4854 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4855 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4856 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4857 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004858
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004859 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004860 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4861 http-response set-status 431
4862 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4863 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004864
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004865http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004867 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4868 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4869 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4870 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4871 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4872 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4873 based on some information from the request.
4874
4875 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4876
4877http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4878
4879 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4880 inline.
4881
4882 Arguments:
4883 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4884 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4885 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4886 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4887 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4888 (request and response)
4889 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4890 processing
4891 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4892 processing
4893 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4894 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4895 and '_'.
4896
4897 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4898 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004899
4900 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004901 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004903http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004904
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004905 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4906 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4907 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4908 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4909 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4910 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4911 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4912 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4913 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4914 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4915 action.
4916 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4917 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4918 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4919 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4920 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004921
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004922http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4923http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4924http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004926 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4927 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4928 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4929 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4930 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4931 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4932
4933http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4934
4935 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4936 about <var-name>.
4937
4938 Example:
4939 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4940
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004941
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004942http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4943 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4944
4945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4946 yes | no | yes | yes
4947
4948 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004949 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
4950 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
4951 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004952
4953 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4954
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004955 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
4956 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
4957 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
4958 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
4959 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
4960 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
4961 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
4962 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
4963 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
4964 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004965
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004966 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
4967 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
4968 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
4969 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
4970 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
4971 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
4972 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
4973 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004974
4975 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4976 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4977 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4978 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4979 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4980 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4981 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4982 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4983 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4984 downsides of rare connection failures.
4985
4986 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4987 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4988 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4989 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4990 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4991 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004992 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004993 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4994 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4995 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4996 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4997 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4998
4999 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005000 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5001 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5002 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005003
5004 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005005 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005006
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005007 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5008 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005009
5010 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5011 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5012 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5013
5014 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5015 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5016 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5017
5018 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5019
5020
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005021http-send-name-header [<header>]
5022 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5023
5024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5025 yes | no | yes | yes
5026
5027 Arguments :
5028
5029 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5030
5031 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005032 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005033 is added with the header string proved.
5034
5035 See also : "server"
5036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005037id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005038 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5040 no | yes | yes | yes
5041 Arguments : none
5042
5043 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5044 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5045 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005046
5047
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005048ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5049 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5050 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005051 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005052
5053 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5054 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5055 and running).
5056
5057 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5058 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5059 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005060 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005061 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5062
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005063 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5064 "unless" condition is met.
5065
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005066 Example:
5067 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5068 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5069 ignore-persist if url_static
5070
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005071 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5072
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005073load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5074 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5075 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5076 yes | no | yes | yes
5077
5078 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5079 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5080 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005081 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005082 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5083 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5084 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5085 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5086
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005087 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005088 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005089 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005090
5091 Arguments:
5092 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5093 named "server-state-file".
5094
5095 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5096 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5097 name is used as a file name.
5098
5099 none don't load any stat for this backend
5100
5101 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005102 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5103 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5104 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005105 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005106 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005107
5108 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5109 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5110
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005111 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005112
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005113 global
5114 stats socket /tmp/socket
5115 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005116
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005117 defaults
5118 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005119
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005120 backend bk
5121 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5122 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005123
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005124
5125 Then one can run :
5126
5127 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5128
5129 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5130
5131 1
5132 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5133 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5134 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5135
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005136 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005137
5138 global
5139 stats socket /tmp/socket
5140 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5141
5142 defaults
5143 load-server-state-from-file local
5144
5145 backend bk
5146 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5147 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5148
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005149
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005150 Then one can run :
5151
5152 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5153
5154 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5155
5156 1
5157 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5158 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5159 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5160
5161 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5162 "show servers state"
5163
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005164
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005165log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005166log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005167no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005168 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5170 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005171
5172 Prefix :
5173 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5174 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5175 prefix does not allow arguments.
5176
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005177 Arguments :
5178 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5179 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5180 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5181 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5182 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5183 parameter.
5184
5185 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5186 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5187
5188 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5189 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5190 standard syslog port).
5191
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005192 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5193 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5194 standard syslog port).
5195
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005196 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5197 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5198 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005199 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005200
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005201 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5202 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5203 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5204 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5205 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5206 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5207 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5208 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5209 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5210 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5211 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5212 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5213 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5214 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5215 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5216 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005217 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5218 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005219
5220 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5221 and "fd@2", see above.
5222
5223 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5224 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005225
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005226 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5227 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5228 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5229 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5230 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5231 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5232 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5233 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5234 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5235 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005236 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005237
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005238 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5239 one of the following :
5240
5241 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5242 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5243
5244 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5245 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5246
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005247 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5248 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5249 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5250 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5251 systemd logger consumes.
5252
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005253 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5254 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5255 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5256 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5257
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005258 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5259
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005260 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5261 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5262 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5263
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005264 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5265 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5266 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5267 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005268
5269 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5270 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5271 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005272 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5273 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5274 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5275 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5276 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005277
5278 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5279
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005280 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5281 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5282 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005283
5284 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5285 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5286 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5287 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5288
5289 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5290 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005291
5292 Example :
5293 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005294 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5295 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5296 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005297 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5298 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005299 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005300
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005301
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005302log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005303 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5304 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5305 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005306
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005307 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5308 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5309 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5310 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5311 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005312
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005313 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5314 "option httplog" directives.
5315
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005316log-format-sd <string>
5317 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5318 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5319 yes | yes | yes | no
5320
5321 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5322 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5323 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5324 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5325 which covers the log format string in depth.
5326
5327 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5328 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5329
5330 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5331 log format to "rfc5424".
5332
5333 Example :
5334 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5335
5336
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005337log-tag <string>
5338 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5339 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5340 yes | yes | yes | yes
5341
5342 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5343 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5344 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5345 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5346 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5347 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5348 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5349 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5350 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005351
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005352max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5353 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5354 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5355 yes | no | yes | yes
5356
5357 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5358 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5359 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5360 servers.
5361
5362 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5363 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5364 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5365 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5366 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005367 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005368 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5369 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5370 picking a different server.
5371
5372 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5373 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5374 even if they have to be queued.
5375
5376 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5377 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5378
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005379max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5380 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5381 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5382 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005383
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005384maxconn <conns>
5385 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5387 yes | yes | yes | no
5388 Arguments :
5389 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5390 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5391 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5392 closes.
5393
5394 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5395 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5396 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5397 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005398 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5399 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5400 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5401 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005402
5403 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5404 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5405 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5406
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005407 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5408
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005409 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5410
5411
5412mode { tcp|http|health }
5413 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5415 yes | yes | yes | yes
5416 Arguments :
5417 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5418 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5419 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5420 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5421
5422 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5423 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5424 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5425 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5426 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5427
5428 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005429 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5430 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5431 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5432 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5433 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5434 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5435 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005436
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005437 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5438 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5439 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005440
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005441 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005442 defaults http_instances
5443 mode http
5444
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005445 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005447
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005448monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005449 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5451 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005452 Arguments :
5453 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5454 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005455 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005456 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5457 backend and its backup.
5458
5459 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5460 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5461 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5462 servers in a list of backends.
5463
5464 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5465 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5466 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5467 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5468 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5469 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5470 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005471 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5472 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005473
5474 Example:
5475 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005476 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005477 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5478 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5479 monitor-uri /site_alive
5480 monitor fail if site_dead
5481
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005482 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005483
5484
5485monitor-net <source>
5486 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5488 yes | yes | yes | no
5489 Arguments :
5490 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5491 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5492 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5493 followed by a mask.
5494
5495 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5496 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005497 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005498 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5499
5500 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5501 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5502 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5503 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005504 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5505 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5506 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005507
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005508 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5509 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5510 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5511 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5512 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5513 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005514
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005515 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5516 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005517
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005518 Example :
5519 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5520 frontend www
5521 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5522
5523 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5524
5525
5526monitor-uri <uri>
5527 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5529 yes | yes | yes | no
5530 Arguments :
5531 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5532 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5533
5534 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5535 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5536 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5537 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5538 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5539 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5540 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5541 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5542
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005543 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5544 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5545 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5546 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5547 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5548 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5549 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5550 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005551
5552 Example :
5553 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5554 frontend www
5555 mode http
5556 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5557
5558 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5559
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005560
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005561option abortonclose
5562no option abortonclose
5563 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5565 yes | no | yes | yes
5566 Arguments : none
5567
5568 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5569 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5570 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5571 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005572 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005573 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5574 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5575 encountered while delivering the response.
5576
5577 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5578 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5579 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5580 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5581 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5582 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005583 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005584 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005585 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005586 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5587 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5588 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5589
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005590 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5591 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005592 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5593 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5594 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5595 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5596 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5597 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005598 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005599
5600 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5601 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5602
5603 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5604
5605
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005606option accept-invalid-http-request
5607no option accept-invalid-http-request
5608 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5610 yes | yes | yes | no
5611 Arguments : none
5612
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005613 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005614 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005615 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005616 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5617 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5618 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5619 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5620 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005621 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5622 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5623 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5624 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005625 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005626 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005627 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5628 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5629 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005630
5631 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5632 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5633 been confirmed.
5634
5635 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5636 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005637 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5638 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005639 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5640
5641 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5642 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5643
5644 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5645 stats socket.
5646
5647
5648option accept-invalid-http-response
5649no option accept-invalid-http-response
5650 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5652 yes | no | yes | yes
5653 Arguments : none
5654
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005655 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005656 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005657 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005658 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5659 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5660 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5661 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5662 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005663 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5664 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5665 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005666
5667 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5668 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5669 been confirmed.
5670
5671 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5672 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5673 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5674 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5675
5676 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5677 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5678
5679 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5680 stats socket.
5681
5682
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005683option allbackups
5684no option allbackups
5685 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5687 yes | no | yes | yes
5688 Arguments : none
5689
5690 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5691 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5692 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5693 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5694 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5695 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5696 order between the backup servers anymore.
5697
5698 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5699 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5700
5701 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5702 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5703
5704
5705option checkcache
5706no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005707 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5709 yes | no | yes | yes
5710 Arguments : none
5711
5712 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5713 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005714 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005715 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5716 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005717 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005718
5719 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005720 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005721 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005722 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5723 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005724 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005725 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005726 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5727 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005728 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005729 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5730 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005731 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005732 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5733 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5734 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5735 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5736 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5737 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5738 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5739 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5740 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5741
5742 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005743 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005744 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005745 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005746 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5747
5748 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5749 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005750 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005751 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005752
5753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5755
5756
5757option clitcpka
5758no option clitcpka
5759 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5761 yes | yes | yes | no
5762 Arguments : none
5763
5764 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5765 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005766 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005767 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5768
5769 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5770 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5771 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5772 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5773
5774 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5775 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5776 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5777 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5778 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5779
5780 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5781
5782 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5783 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5784 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5785
5786 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5787 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5788
5789 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5790
5791
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005792option contstats
5793 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5795 yes | yes | yes | no
5796 Arguments : none
5797
5798 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5799 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5800 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5801 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005802 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5803 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5804 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5805 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5806 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005807
5808
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005809option dontlog-normal
5810no option dontlog-normal
5811 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5813 yes | yes | yes | no
5814 Arguments : none
5815
5816 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5817 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5818 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5819 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5820 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5821 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5822 logged.
5823
5824 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5825 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5826 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005828 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005829 logging.
5830
5831
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005832option dontlognull
5833no option dontlognull
5834 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5836 yes | yes | yes | no
5837 Arguments : none
5838
5839 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5840 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5841 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5842 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5843 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5844 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005845 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5846 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5847 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005848
5849 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005850 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005851 would not be logged.
5852
5853 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5854 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5855
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005856 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5857 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005858
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005859
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005860option forceclose (deprecated)
5861no option forceclose (deprecated)
5862 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005863
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005864 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005865
5866
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005867option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005868 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5870 yes | yes | yes | yes
5871 Arguments :
5872 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5873 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005874 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005875 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005876
5877 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5878 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5879 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5880 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5881 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5882 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5883 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005884 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5885 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5886 possible that the client has already brought one.
5887
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005888 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005889 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005890 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005891 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005892 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005893 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005894
5895 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5896 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5897 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5898 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5899 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5900 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5901 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5902
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005903 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5904 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5905 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5906 are under the control of the end-user.
5907
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005908 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005909 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5910 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005911 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5912 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5913 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005914
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005915 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005916 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5917 frontend www
5918 mode http
5919 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5920
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005921 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5922 backend www
5923 mode http
5924 option forwardfor header X-Client
5925
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005926 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005927 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005928
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005929
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005930option http-buffer-request
5931no option http-buffer-request
5932 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5934 yes | yes | yes | yes
5935 Arguments : none
5936
5937 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5938 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5939 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5940 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5941 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5942 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5943 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5944 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005945 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005946 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5947 default.
5948
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005949 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005950
5951
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005952option http-ignore-probes
5953no option http-ignore-probes
5954 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5956 yes | yes | yes | no
5957 Arguments : none
5958
5959 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5960 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5961 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5962 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5963 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5964 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5965 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5966 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5967 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005968 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5969 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005970 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5971
5972 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5973 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5974 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5975 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5976 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5977 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5978 are often the only way to detect them.
5979
5980 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5981 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5982
5983 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5984
5985
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005986option http-keep-alive
5987no option http-keep-alive
5988 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5990 yes | yes | yes | yes
5991 Arguments : none
5992
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005993 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5994 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005995 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5996 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5997 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
5998 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
5999 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006000
6001 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6002 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006003 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6004 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6005 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6006 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6007 situations where this option may be useful :
6008
6009 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006010 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006011
6012 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6013 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6014
6015 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6016 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6017 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6018 request.
6019
6020 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6021 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006022 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6023 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6024 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006025
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006026 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6027 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6028 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6029 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6030 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6031 not set.
6032
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006033 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006034 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6035 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006036
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006037 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006038 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006039 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006040
6041
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006042option http-no-delay
6043no option http-no-delay
6044 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6046 yes | yes | yes | yes
6047 Arguments : none
6048
6049 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6050 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6051 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6052 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6053 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6054 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6055 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6056 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6057 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6058 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6059 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6060 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6061 affected.
6062
6063 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6064 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6065 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6066 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6067 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6068 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6069 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6070 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6071 latency environments.
6072
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006073 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6074
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006075
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006076option http-pretend-keepalive
6077no option http-pretend-keepalive
6078 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006080 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006081 Arguments : none
6082
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006083 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006084 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6085 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6086 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6087 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6088 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6089 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6090 consider the response complete.
6091
6092 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6093 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6094 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6095 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006096 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006097 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6098
6099 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6100 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6101 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6102 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6103 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6104 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6105 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6106
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006107 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6108 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6109 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6110 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6111 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6112 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006113
6114 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6115 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6116
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006117 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006118 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006119
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006120
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006121option http-server-close
6122no option http-server-close
6123 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 yes | yes | yes | yes
6126 Arguments : none
6127
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006128 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6129 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6130 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6131 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006132 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6133 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6134 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6135 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6136 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6137 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6138 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6139 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6140 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6141 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6142 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006143
6144 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6145 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6146 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6147 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006148 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6149 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006150
6151 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6152 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006153 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6154 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6155 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006156
6157 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6158 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6159
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006160 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6161 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006162
6163
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006164option http-tunnel
6165no option http-tunnel
6166 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006168 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006169 Arguments : none
6170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006171 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6172 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6173 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6174 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006175 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006176
6177 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006178 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006179 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6180 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6181 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6182 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6183 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6184 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6185 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006186
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006187 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6188 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6189 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6190 backend.
6191
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006192 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6193 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6194
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006195 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6196 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006197
6198
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006199option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006200no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006201 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6203 yes | yes | yes | no
6204 Arguments : none
6205
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006206 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006207 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6208 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6209 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6210 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6211 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6212 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6213
6214 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6215 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006216 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6217 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6218 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006219
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006220 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6221 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6222 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6223 front of an existing proxy.
6224
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006225 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6226
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006227 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006228
6229
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006230option http-use-htx
6231no option http-use-htx
6232 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6234 yes | yes | yes | yes
6235 Arguments : none
6236
6237 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6238 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6239 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6240 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6241 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6242 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6243 representation.
6244
6245 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6246 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6247 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6248 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6249 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6250 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6251 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6252 other side's version.
6253
6254 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6255 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6256 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6257 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6258 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6259
6260 See also : "mode http"
6261
6262
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006263option httpchk
6264option httpchk <uri>
6265option httpchk <method> <uri>
6266option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6267 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6269 yes | no | yes | yes
6270 Arguments :
6271 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6272 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6273 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6274 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6275 ones.
6276
6277 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6278 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6279 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6280
6281 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6282 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6283 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6284 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6285 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6286
6287 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6288 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6289 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6290 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6291 the lack of any response.
6292
6293 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6294
6295 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6296 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6297 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6298
6299 Examples :
6300 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6301 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6302 backend https_relay
6303 mode tcp
6304 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6305 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6306
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006307 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6308 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6309 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006310
6311
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006312option httpclose
6313no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006314 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6316 yes | yes | yes | yes
6317 Arguments : none
6318
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006319 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6320 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6321 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6322 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006323 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006324
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006325 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6326 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6327 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6328 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6329 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006330
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006331 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6332 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6333 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006334
6335 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6336 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006337 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006338 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6339 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6340 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006341
6342 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6343 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6344
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006345 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006346
6347
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006348option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006349 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006351 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006352 Arguments :
6353 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6354 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6355 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006356 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006357 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006358
6359 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6360 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6361 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6362 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6363 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6364 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6365 ports.
6366
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006367 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6368 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006369
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006370 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006372 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006373
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006374
6375option http_proxy
6376no option http_proxy
6377 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6379 yes | yes | yes | yes
6380 Arguments : none
6381
6382 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6383 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6384 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6385 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6386 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6387
6388 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6389 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006390 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6391 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006392
6393 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6394 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6395
6396 Example :
6397 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6398 backend direct_forward
6399 option httpclose
6400 option http_proxy
6401
6402 See also : "option httpclose"
6403
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006404
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006405option independent-streams
6406no option independent-streams
6407 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6409 yes | yes | yes | yes
6410 Arguments : none
6411
6412 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6413 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6414 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6415 receive data or not.
6416
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006417 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006418 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6419 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6420 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6421 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6422 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6423 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6424 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6425 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6426 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6427 socket buffers.
6428
6429 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6430 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6431 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6432 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6433 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6434
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006435 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006436 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6437 deprecated.
6438
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006439 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006440
6441
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006442option ldap-check
6443 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6445 yes | no | yes | yes
6446 Arguments : none
6447
6448 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6449 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6450 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6451 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6452
6453 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6454 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6455
6456 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6457 configure it.
6458
6459 Example :
6460 option ldap-check
6461
6462 See also : "option httpchk"
6463
6464
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006465option external-check
6466 Use external processes for server health checks
6467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6468 yes | no | yes | yes
6469
6470 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6471 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6472 command".
6473
6474 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6475
6476 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6477
6478
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006479option log-health-checks
6480no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006481 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 yes | no | yes | yes
6484 Arguments : none
6485
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006486 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6487 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6488 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006489
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006490 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6491 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6492 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6493 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6494 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6495
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006496 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006497 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006498
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006499 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6500 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6501 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006502
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006503
6504option log-separate-errors
6505no option log-separate-errors
6506 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6508 yes | yes | yes | no
6509 Arguments : none
6510
6511 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6512 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6513 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6514 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6515 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6516 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6517 provides very important information.
6518
6519 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6520 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6521 error logs.
6522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006523 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006524 logging.
6525
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006526
6527option logasap
6528no option logasap
6529 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6531 yes | yes | yes | no
6532 Arguments : none
6533
6534 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6535 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6536 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6537 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6538 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6539 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6540 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006541 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006542 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6543 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6544
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006545 Examples :
6546 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6547 mode http
6548 option httplog
6549 option logasap
6550 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6551
6552 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6553 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6554 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6555 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006557 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006558 logging.
6559
6560
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006561option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006562 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6564 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006565 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006566 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6567 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006568 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006569
6570 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6571 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006572 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006573 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6574 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6575 in the MySQL table, like this :
6576
6577 USE mysql;
6578 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6579 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6580
6581 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006582 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006583 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6584 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6585 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6586 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6587 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6588 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6589 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6590
6591 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6592 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006593
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006594 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006595
6596 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6597 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6598 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6599 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006600 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6601 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006602
6603 See also: "option httpchk"
6604
6605
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006606option nolinger
6607no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006608 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006609 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6610 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006611 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006612
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006613 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006614 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6615 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6616 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6617 connections.
6618
6619 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6620 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6621 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6622 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6623 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6624 this too.
6625
6626 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6627 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6628 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6629
6630 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6631 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6632 for servers.
6633
6634 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6635 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6636
6637
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006638option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6639 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6641 yes | yes | yes | yes
6642 Arguments :
6643 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6644 matching <network>
6645 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6646 header name.
6647
6648 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6649 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6650 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6651 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6652 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6653 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6654 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6655 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6656 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6657 possible that the client has already brought one.
6658
6659 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6660 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6661 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6662 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6663 header and requires different one.
6664
6665 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6666 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6667 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6668 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6669 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6670 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6671 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6672
6673 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6674 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6675 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6676 both are defined.
6677
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006678 Examples :
6679 # Original Destination address
6680 frontend www
6681 mode http
6682 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6683
6684 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6685 backend www
6686 mode http
6687 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6688
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006689 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006690
6691
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006692option persist
6693no option persist
6694 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6695 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6696 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006697 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006698
6699 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6700 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6701 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6702 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6703 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6704 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6705 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6706 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6707 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6708 redirected to another valid server.
6709
6710 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6711 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6712
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006713 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006714
6715
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006716option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6717 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6719 yes | no | yes | yes
6720 Arguments :
6721 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6722 PostgreSQL server.
6723
6724 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6725 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6726 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6727 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6728
6729 See also: "option httpchk"
6730
6731
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006732option prefer-last-server
6733no option prefer-last-server
6734 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6735 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6736 yes | no | yes | yes
6737 Arguments : none
6738
6739 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6740 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6741 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6742 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6743 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6744 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6745 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6746 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6747 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006748 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6749 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006750 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6751 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6752 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006753 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6754 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6755 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006756
6757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6759
6760 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6761
6762
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006763option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006764option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006765no option redispatch
6766 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6767 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6768 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006769 Arguments :
6770 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6771 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6772 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006773 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006774 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006775 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006776 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6777 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6778 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006780
6781 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6782 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6783 be able to access the service anymore.
6784
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006785 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6786 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006787
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006788 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006789 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6790 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006792 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6793 "redisp" keywords.
6794
6795 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6796 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6797
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006798 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006799
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006800
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006801option redis-check
6802 Use redis health checks for server testing
6803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6804 yes | no | yes | yes
6805 Arguments : none
6806
6807 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6808 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6809 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6810 find the "+PONG" response message.
6811
6812 Example :
6813 option redis-check
6814
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006815 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006816
6817
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006818option smtpchk
6819option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6820 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6822 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006823 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006824 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006825 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006826 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6827
6828 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6829 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6830 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6831
6832 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6833 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6834 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6835 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6836 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6837 dead server.
6838
6839 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6840 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006841 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006842 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6843
6844 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6845 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6846 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6847 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006848 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006849
6850 Example :
6851 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6852
6853 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006855
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006856option socket-stats
6857no option socket-stats
6858
6859 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6861 yes | yes | yes | no
6862
6863 Arguments : none
6864
6865
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006866option splice-auto
6867no option splice-auto
6868 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6870 yes | yes | yes | yes
6871 Arguments : none
6872
6873 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6874 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006875 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006876 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006877 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006878 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6879 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6880 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6881 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6882
6883 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6884 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6885 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6886 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6887 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6888 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6889 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6890 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6891 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6892 keyword.
6893
6894 Example :
6895 option splice-auto
6896
6897 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6898 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6899
6900 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6901 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6902
6903
6904option splice-request
6905no option splice-request
6906 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6908 yes | yes | yes | yes
6909 Arguments : none
6910
6911 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006912 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006913 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6914 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6915 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6916 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6917
6918 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6919
6920 Example :
6921 option splice-request
6922
6923 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6924 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6925
6926 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6927 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6928
6929
6930option splice-response
6931no option splice-response
6932 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6934 yes | yes | yes | yes
6935 Arguments : none
6936
6937 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006938 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006939 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6940 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6941 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6942 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6943
6944 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6945
6946 Example :
6947 option splice-response
6948
6949 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6950 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6951
6952 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6953 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6954
6955
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006956option spop-check
6957 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6959 no | no | no | yes
6960 Arguments : none
6961
6962 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6963 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6964 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6965 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6966
6967 Example :
6968 option spop-check
6969
6970 See also : "option httpchk"
6971
6972
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006973option srvtcpka
6974no option srvtcpka
6975 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6977 yes | no | yes | yes
6978 Arguments : none
6979
6980 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6981 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006982 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006983 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6984
6985 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6986 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6987 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6988 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6989
6990 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6991 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6992 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6993 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6994 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6995
6996 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6997
6998 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6999 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7000 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7001
7002 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7003 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7004
7005 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7006
7007
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007008option ssl-hello-chk
7009 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7011 yes | no | yes | yes
7012 Arguments : none
7013
7014 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7015 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7016 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7017 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7018 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7019 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7020 hello message.
7021
7022 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7023 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7024 messages, which is appreciable.
7025
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007026 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7027 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7028 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007029
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007030 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7031
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007032
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007033option tcp-check
7034 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7035 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 yes | no | yes | yes
7037
7038 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7039 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7040
7041 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7042 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7043 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7044
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007045 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007046 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7047 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7048 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7049 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7050 only.
7051
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007052 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007053 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7054 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7055 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7056 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7057
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007058 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007059 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7060 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007061 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007062 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7063 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7064 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7065 the respective protocols.
7066 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007067 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007068
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007069 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7070 script.
7071
7072 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7073 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7074 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7075 The "comment" is of course optional.
7076
7077
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007078 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007079 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007080 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007081 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007082
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007083 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007084 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007085 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007086
7087 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7088 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007089 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007090 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007091 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007092 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007093 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007094 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007095 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7096 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007097 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007098 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7099 tcp-check expect string +OK
7100
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007101 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007102 (send many headers before analyzing)
7103 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007104 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007105 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7106 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7107 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7108 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007109 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007110
7111
7112 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7113
7114
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007115option tcp-smart-accept
7116no option tcp-smart-accept
7117 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7119 yes | yes | yes | no
7120 Arguments : none
7121
7122 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7123 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7124 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7125 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7126 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7127 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7128
7129 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7130 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7131 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7132 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7133
7134 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7135 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7136 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007137 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007138
7139 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7140 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7141 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7142
7143 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7144 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7145 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7146
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007147 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7148
7149
7150option tcp-smart-connect
7151no option tcp-smart-connect
7152 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7154 yes | no | yes | yes
7155 Arguments : none
7156
7157 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7158 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7159 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7160 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7161 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7162
7163 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7164 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7165 complex.
7166
7167 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7168 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7169 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7170
7171 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7172 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7173
7174 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7175
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007176
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007177option tcpka
7178 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7180 yes | yes | yes | yes
7181 Arguments : none
7182
7183 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7184 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007185 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007186 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7187
7188 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7189 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7190 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7191 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7192
7193 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7194 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7195 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7196 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7197 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7198
7199 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7200
7201 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7202 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7203 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7204 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7205 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7206 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7207 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7208 backends.
7209
7210 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7211
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007212
7213option tcplog
7214 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007216 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007217 Arguments : none
7218
7219 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7220 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7221 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7222 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7223 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7224 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7225 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7226 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7227
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007228 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007230 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007231
7232
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007233option transparent
7234no option transparent
7235 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007237 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007238 Arguments : none
7239
7240 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7241 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7242 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7243 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7244 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7245 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7246 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7247 appropriate server.
7248
7249 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7250 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7251
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007252 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007253 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007254
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007255
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007256external-check command <command>
7257 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7259 yes | no | yes | yes
7260
7261 Arguments :
7262 <command> is the external command to run
7263
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007264 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7265
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007266 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007267
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007268 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7269 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7270 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7271 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7272 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7273 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007274
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007275 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7276
7277 Environment variables :
7278 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7279 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7280
7281 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7282
7283 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7284
7285 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7286 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7287 for a UNIX socket).
7288
7289 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7290
7291 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7292
7293 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7294
7295 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7296
7297 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7298
7299 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7300 socket).
7301
7302 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7303 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7304
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007305 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7306 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7307 failed.
7308
7309 Example :
7310 external-check command /bin/true
7311
7312 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7313
7314
7315external-check path <path>
7316 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7318 yes | no | yes | yes
7319
7320 Arguments :
7321 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7322
7323 The default path is "".
7324
7325 Example :
7326 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7327
7328 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7329 "external-check command"
7330
7331
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007332persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007333persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007334 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7336 yes | no | yes | yes
7337 Arguments :
7338 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007339 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7340 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007341
7342 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7343 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007344 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007345 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7346 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7347 forwarded to this server.
7348
7349 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7350 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7351 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007352 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007353 a single "listen" section.
7354
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007355 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7356 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7357 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7358
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007359 Example :
7360 listen tse-farm
7361 bind :3389
7362 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7363 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7364 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7365 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7366 persist rdp-cookie
7367 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007368 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007369 balance rdp-cookie
7370 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7371 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7372
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007373 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7374 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007375
7376
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007377rate-limit sessions <rate>
7378 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7380 yes | yes | yes | no
7381 Arguments :
7382 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7383 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7384
7385 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7386 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7387 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7388 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7389 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7390 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7391
7392 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7393 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7394 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7395 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7396
7397 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7398 listen smtp
7399 mode tcp
7400 bind :25
7401 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007402 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007403
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007404 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7405 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7406 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007407
7408 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7409
7410
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007411redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7412redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7413redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007414 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7416 no | yes | yes | yes
7417
7418 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007419 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007420
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007421 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007422 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007423 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7424 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7425 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007426
7427 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7428 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7429 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7430 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7431 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007432 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7433 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7434 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7435 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007436
7437 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7438 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7439 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7440 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7441 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7442 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007443 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007444 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007445 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7446 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7447 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007448
7449 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007450 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7451 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7452 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007453 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007454 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7455 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7456 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7457 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007458
7459 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007460 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007461
7462 - "drop-query"
7463 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7464 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7465 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7466 with a location-type redirect.
7467
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007468 - "append-slash"
7469 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7470 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7471 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7472 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7473
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007474 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7475 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7476 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7477 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7478 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7479 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7480 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7481
7482 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7483 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7484 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7485 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7486 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7487 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7488 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007489
7490 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7491 acl clear dst_port 80
7492 acl secure dst_port 8080
7493 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007494 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007495 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007496 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7497
7498 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007499 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7500 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7501 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007502 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007503
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007504 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7505 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7506 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7507
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007508 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007509 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007510
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007511 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007512 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7513 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7514 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007516 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007517
7518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007519redisp (deprecated)
7520redispatch (deprecated)
7521 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7522 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7523 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007524 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007525
7526 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7527 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7528 be able to access the service anymore.
7529
7530 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7531 redistribute them to a working server.
7532
7533 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7534 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7535 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007537 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7538 "option redispatch" instead.
7539
7540 See also : "option redispatch"
7541
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007542
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007543reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007544 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7546 no | yes | yes | yes
7547 Arguments :
7548 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7549 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007550 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007551
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007552 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7553 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7554
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007555 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7556 the last header of an HTTP request.
7557
7558 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7559 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7560 responses.
7561
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007562 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7563 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7564 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7565
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007566 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7567 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007568
7569
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007570reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7571reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007572 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7574 no | yes | yes | yes
7575 Arguments :
7576 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7577 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7578 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7579 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7580 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7581 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7582 ignores case.
7583
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007584 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7585 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7586
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007587 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7588 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7589 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7590 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007591 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007592
7593 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7594 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7595
7596 Example :
7597 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7598 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7599 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7600
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007601 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7602 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007603
7604
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007605reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7606reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007607 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7609 no | yes | yes | yes
7610 Arguments :
7611 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7612 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7613 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7614 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7615 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7616 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7617
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007618 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7619 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7620
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007621 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7622 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7623 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7624 next servers.
7625
7626 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7627 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7628 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7629
7630 Example :
7631 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7632 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7633 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7634
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007635 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7636 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007637
7638
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007639reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7640reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007641 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7643 no | yes | yes | yes
7644 Arguments :
7645 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7646 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7647 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7648 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7649 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7650 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7651 case.
7652
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007653 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7654 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7655
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007656 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7657 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7658 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7659 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007660 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007661
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007662 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007663 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007664 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007665
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007666 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7667 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7668
7669 Example :
7670 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7671 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7672 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7673
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007674 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7675 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007676
7677
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007678reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7679reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007680 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7682 no | yes | yes | yes
7683 Arguments :
7684 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7685 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7686 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7687 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7688 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7689 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7690 case.
7691
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007692 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7693 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7694
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007695 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7696 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7697 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7698 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7699
7700 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7701 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7702
7703 Example :
7704 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7705 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7706 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7707 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7708
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007709 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7710 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007711
7712
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007713reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7714reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007715 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7717 no | yes | yes | yes
7718 Arguments :
7719 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7720 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7721 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7722 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7723 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7724 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7725
7726 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7727 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7728 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7729 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007730 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007731
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007732 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7733 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7734
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007735 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7736 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7737 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7738
7739 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7740 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7741 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7742 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7743 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7744
7745 Example :
7746 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007747 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007748 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7749 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7750
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007751 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7752 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007753
7754
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007755reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7756reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007757 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7759 no | yes | yes | yes
7760 Arguments :
7761 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7762 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7763 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7764 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7765 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7766 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7767 ignores case.
7768
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007769 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7770 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7771
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007772 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7773 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007774 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7775 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7776 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007777 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7778 not set.
7779
7780 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7781 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7782 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7783 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7784 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7785
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007786 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007787 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007788 # block all others.
7789 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7790 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7791
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007792 # block bad guys
7793 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7794 reqitarpit . if badguys
7795
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007796 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7797 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007798
7799
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007800retries <value>
7801 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7803 yes | no | yes | yes
7804 Arguments :
7805 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7806 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7807 default value is 3.
7808
7809 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7810 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7811 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7812
7813 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007814 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7815 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007816
7817 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7818 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7819
7820 See also : "option redispatch"
7821
7822
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007823rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007824 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7826 no | yes | yes | yes
7827 Arguments :
7828 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7829 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007830 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007831
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007832 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7833 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7834
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007835 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7836 the last header of an HTTP response.
7837
7838 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7839 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7840 responses.
7841
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007842 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7843 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007844
7845
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007846rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7847rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007848 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7850 no | yes | yes | yes
7851 Arguments :
7852 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7853 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7854 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7855 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7856 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7857 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7858 ignores case.
7859
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007860 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7861 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7862
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007863 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7864 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007865 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007866 client.
7867
7868 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7869 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7870 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7871
7872 Example :
7873 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007874 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007875
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007876 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7877 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007878
7879
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007880rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7881rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007882 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7884 no | yes | yes | yes
7885 Arguments :
7886 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7887 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7888 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7889 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7890 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7891 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7892 ignores case.
7893
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007894 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7895 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7896
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007897 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7898 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7899 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7900 case-sensitive.
7901
7902 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007903 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7904 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7905 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007906
7907 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7908 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7909
7910 Example :
7911 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7912 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7913
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007914 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7915 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007916
7917
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007918rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7919rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007920 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7922 no | yes | yes | yes
7923 Arguments :
7924 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7925 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7926 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7927 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7928 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7929 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7930 ignores case.
7931
7932 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7933 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7934 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7935 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007936 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007937
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007938 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7939 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7940
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007941 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7942 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7943 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7944
7945 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7946 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7947 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7948 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7949 are not case-sensitive.
7950
7951 Example :
7952 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7953 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7954
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007955 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7956 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007957
7958
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007959server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007960 Declare a server in a backend
7961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7962 no | no | yes | yes
7963 Arguments :
7964 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007965 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007966 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007967
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007968 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7969 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7970 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7971 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007972 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7973 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7974 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7975 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7976 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007977 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7978 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7979 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7980 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7981 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7982 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7983 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007984 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007985 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7986 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7987 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7988 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7989 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7990 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007991 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7992 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007993 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7994 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007995
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007996 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007997 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7998 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7999 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8000 adding this value to the client's port.
8001
8002 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8003 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008004 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008005
8006 Examples :
8007 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8008 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008009 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008010 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8011 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8012 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008013
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008014 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8015 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8016 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8017 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8018 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8019
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008020 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8021 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008022
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008023server-state-file-name [<file>]
8024 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8025 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8026 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8027 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8028 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8029 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8030
8031 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8032 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8033
8034 global
8035 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8036
8037 backend bk
8038 load-server-state-from-file
8039
8040 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8041 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008042
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008043server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8044 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8045 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8047 no | no | yes | yes
8048
8049 Arguments:
8050 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8051
8052 <num | range>
8053 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8054 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8055 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8056 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8057
8058 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8059
8060 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8061
8062 <params*>
8063 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8064 keyword.
8065
8066 Examples:
8067 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8068 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8069 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8070
8071 # or
8072 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8073
8074 # would be equivalent to:
8075 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8076 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8077 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8078
8079
8080
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008081source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008082source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008083source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008084 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8086 yes | no | yes | yes
8087 Arguments :
8088 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8089 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008090
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008091 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008092 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8093 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8094 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8095 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8096 supported prefixes are :
8097 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8098 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8099 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008100 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008101 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8102 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008103
8104 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8105 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008106 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8107 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8108 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008109
8110 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8111 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8112 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8113 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8114 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8115 <addr>.
8116
8117 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8118 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8119 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8120 port.
8121
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008122 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8123 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8124 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8125 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008126 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008127 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8128 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8129 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8130 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8131 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8132 HTTP header.
8133
8134 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8135 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008136 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008137 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8138 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8139 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8140 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8141 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8142 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8143 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8144
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008145 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8146 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8147 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8148 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8149 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8150 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8151
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008152 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8153 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8154 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8155 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8156
8157 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8158 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8159 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8160 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8161 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8162 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8163
8164 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8165 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8166 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8167 there are two methods :
8168
8169 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8170 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8171 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8172 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8173 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8174 of the client ranges may be used.
8175
8176 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8177 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8178 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8179 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8180 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8181 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8182 same session.
8183
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008184 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8185 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8186 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008187 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008188
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008189 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8190
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008191 Examples :
8192 backend private
8193 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8194 source 192.168.1.200
8195
8196 backend transparent_ssl1
8197 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8198 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8199
8200 backend transparent_ssl2
8201 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8202 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8203 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8204
8205 backend transparent_ssl3
8206 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8207 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8208 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8209
8210 backend transparent_smtp
8211 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8212 # with Tproxy version 4.
8213 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8214
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008215 backend transparent_http
8216 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8217 # proxy.
8218 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008220 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008221 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8222
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008223
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008224srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8225 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8227 yes | no | yes | yes
8228 Arguments :
8229 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8230 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8231 as explained at the top of this document.
8232
8233 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8234 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8235 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8236 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8237 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8238 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8239 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8240
8241 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8242 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8243 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8244 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8245 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008246 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008247 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008248 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008249
8250 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8251 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8252 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8253 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8254 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8255 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8256
8257 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8258 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8259
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008260 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8261 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008262
8263
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008264stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8265 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008267 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008268
8269 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8270 matched.
8271
8272 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8273 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8274
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008275 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8276 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008277 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008278
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008279 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8280 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8281 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8282 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008283
8284 Example :
8285 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8286 backend stats_localhost
8287 stats enable
8288 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8289
8290 Example :
8291 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8292 backend stats_auth
8293 stats enable
8294 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8295 stats admin if TRUE
8296
8297 Example :
8298 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8299 userlist stats-auth
8300 group admin users admin
8301 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8302 group readonly users haproxy
8303 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8304
8305 backend stats_auth
8306 stats enable
8307 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8308 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8309 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8310 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8311
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008312 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8313 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8314 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008315
8316
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008317stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8318 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008320 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008321 Arguments :
8322 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8323
8324 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8325
8326 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8327 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8328 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8329 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8330 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8331 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8332
8333 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8334 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8335 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008336 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008337
8338 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8339 report using "stats scope".
8340
8341 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8342 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8343 unobvious parameters.
8344
8345 Example :
8346 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8347 backend public_www
8348 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8349 stats enable
8350 stats hide-version
8351 stats scope .
8352 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008353 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008354 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8355 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8356
8357 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8358 backend private_monitoring
8359 stats enable
8360 stats uri /admin?stats
8361 stats refresh 5s
8362
8363 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8364
8365
8366stats enable
8367 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008369 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008370 Arguments : none
8371
8372 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8373 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8374 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8375 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8376 - stats auth : no authentication
8377 - stats scope : no restriction
8378
8379 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8380 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8381 unobvious parameters.
8382
8383 Example :
8384 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8385 backend public_www
8386 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8387 stats enable
8388 stats hide-version
8389 stats scope .
8390 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008391 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008392 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8393 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8394
8395 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8396 backend private_monitoring
8397 stats enable
8398 stats uri /admin?stats
8399 stats refresh 5s
8400
8401 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8402
8403
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008404stats hide-version
8405 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008407 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008408 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008409
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008410 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8411 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8412 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8413 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8414 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8415 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008417 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8418 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8419 unobvious parameters.
8420
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008421 Example :
8422 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8423 backend public_www
8424 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008425 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008426 stats hide-version
8427 stats scope .
8428 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008429 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008430 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8431 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008432
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008433 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8434 backend private_monitoring
8435 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008436 stats uri /admin?stats
8437 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008438
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008439 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008440
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008441
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008442stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8443 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8444 Access control for statistics
8445
8446 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8447 no | no | yes | yes
8448
8449 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8450 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8451 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8452 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8453 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8454 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8455
8456 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8457 instance.
8458
8459 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8460 about ACL usage.
8461
8462
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008463stats realm <realm>
8464 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008466 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008467 Arguments :
8468 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8469 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8470 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8471
8472 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8473 using a backslash ('\').
8474
8475 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8476 only related to authentication.
8477
8478 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8479 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8480 unobvious parameters.
8481
8482 Example :
8483 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8484 backend public_www
8485 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8486 stats enable
8487 stats hide-version
8488 stats scope .
8489 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008490 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008491 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8492 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8493
8494 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8495 backend private_monitoring
8496 stats enable
8497 stats uri /admin?stats
8498 stats refresh 5s
8499
8500 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8501
8502
8503stats refresh <delay>
8504 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008506 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008507 Arguments :
8508 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8509 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8510 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8511 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8512 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8513 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8514
8515 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8516 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8517 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8518 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8519
8520 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8521 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8522 unobvious parameters.
8523
8524 Example :
8525 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8526 backend public_www
8527 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8528 stats enable
8529 stats hide-version
8530 stats scope .
8531 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008532 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008533 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8534 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8535
8536 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8537 backend private_monitoring
8538 stats enable
8539 stats uri /admin?stats
8540 stats refresh 5s
8541
8542 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8543
8544
8545stats scope { <name> | "." }
8546 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008548 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008549 Arguments :
8550 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8551 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8552 section in which the statement appears.
8553
8554 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8555 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8556 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8557 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8558 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8559 exists.
8560
8561 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8562 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8563 unobvious parameters.
8564
8565 Example :
8566 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8567 backend public_www
8568 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8569 stats enable
8570 stats hide-version
8571 stats scope .
8572 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008573 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008574 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8575 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8576
8577 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8578 backend private_monitoring
8579 stats enable
8580 stats uri /admin?stats
8581 stats refresh 5s
8582
8583 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8584
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008585
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008586stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008587 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008589 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008590
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008591 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008592 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8593
8594 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8595 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8596
8597 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8598 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008599 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008600
8601 Example :
8602 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8603 backend private_monitoring
8604 stats enable
8605 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8606 stats uri /admin?stats
8607 stats refresh 5s
8608
8609 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8610 global section.
8611
8612
8613stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008614 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8616 yes | yes | yes | yes
8617 Arguments : none
8618
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008619 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008620 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8621 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8622 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8623 - IP (socket, server)
8624 - cookie (backend, server)
8625
8626 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8627 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008628 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008629
8630 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8631
8632
8633stats show-node [ <name> ]
8634 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008636 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008637 Arguments:
8638 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8639 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8640
8641 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8642 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008643 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008644
8645 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8646 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8647 unobvious parameters.
8648
8649 Example:
8650 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8651 backend private_monitoring
8652 stats enable
8653 stats show-node Europe-1
8654 stats uri /admin?stats
8655 stats refresh 5s
8656
8657 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8658 section.
8659
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008660
8661stats uri <prefix>
8662 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008664 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008665 Arguments :
8666 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8667 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8668 query string.
8669
8670 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8671 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8672 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8673 possible to reach it in the application.
8674
8675 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008676 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008677 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8678 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8679 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8680 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8681
8682 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8683 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8684 an address or a port to statistics only.
8685
8686 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8687 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8688 unobvious parameters.
8689
8690 Example :
8691 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8692 backend public_www
8693 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8694 stats enable
8695 stats hide-version
8696 stats scope .
8697 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008698 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008699 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8700 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8701
8702 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8703 backend private_monitoring
8704 stats enable
8705 stats uri /admin?stats
8706 stats refresh 5s
8707
8708 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8709
8710
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008711stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8712 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008714 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008715
8716 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008717 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008718 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008719 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008720 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8721
8722 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8723 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8724 the "stick-table" statement.
8725
8726 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8727 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8728 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8729 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8730 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8731
8732 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8733 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8734 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8735 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8736 transformation rules.
8737
8738 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8739 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8740 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8741 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8742 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8743 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8744 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8745
8746 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8747 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8748 ACL based conditions.
8749
8750 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8751 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8752 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8753 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8754
8755 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8756 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8757 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8758 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8759
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008760 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8761 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008762 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008763
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008764 Example :
8765 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8766 # last 30 minutes
8767 backend pop
8768 mode tcp
8769 balance roundrobin
8770 stick store-request src
8771 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8772 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8773 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8774
8775 backend smtp
8776 mode tcp
8777 balance roundrobin
8778 stick match src table pop
8779 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8780 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8781
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008782 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008783 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008784
8785
8786stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8787 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8789 no | no | yes | yes
8790
8791 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8792 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8793 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8794 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8795
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008796 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8797 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008798 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008799
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008800 Examples :
8801 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008802 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008803
8804 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8805 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8806 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8807
8808
8809 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8810 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8811 backend http
8812 mode http
8813 balance roundrobin
8814 stick on src table https
8815 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8816 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8817 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8818
8819 backend https
8820 mode tcp
8821 balance roundrobin
8822 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8823 stick on src
8824 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8825 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8826
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008827 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008828
8829
8830stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8831 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8833 no | no | yes | yes
8834
8835 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008836 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008837 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008838 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008839 server is selected.
8840
8841 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8842 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8843 the "stick-table" statement.
8844
8845 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8846 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8847 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8848 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8849 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8850 address.
8851
8852 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8853 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8854 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8855 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8856 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8857 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8858 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8859 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8860 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8861 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8862
8863 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8864 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8865 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8866 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8867 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8868 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8869 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8870
8871 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8872 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8873 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8874 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8875
8876 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8877 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8878 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8879 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8880 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8881 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008882 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8883 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8884 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8885 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8886 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8887 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008888
8889 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8890 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8891 the request.
8892
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008893 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8894 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008895 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008896
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008897 Example :
8898 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8899 # last 30 minutes
8900 backend pop
8901 mode tcp
8902 balance roundrobin
8903 stick store-request src
8904 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8905 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8906 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8907
8908 backend smtp
8909 mode tcp
8910 balance roundrobin
8911 stick match src table pop
8912 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8913 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8914
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008915 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008916 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008917
8918
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008919stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008920 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8921 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008922 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008924 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008925
8926 Arguments :
8927 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8928 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8929 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8930 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8931
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008932 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8933 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8934 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8935 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8936
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008937 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8938 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8939 instance.
8940
8941 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8942 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8943 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8944 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8945 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8946 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008947 to 32 characters.
8948
8949 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8950 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8951 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008952 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008953 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8954 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008955
8956 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008957 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8958 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008959 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8960 increase.
8961
8962 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008963 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8964 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8965 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008966
8967 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8968 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8969 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8970 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008971 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008972 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8973 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8974 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8975 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8976 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8977 parameter (see below).
8978
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008979 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8980 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8981 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8982 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8983 soft restart.
8984
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008985 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8986 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008987
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008988 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8989 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8990 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8991 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008992 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008993 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008994 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8995 if not expiration delay is specified.
8996
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008997 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8998 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8999 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9000 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009001 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9002 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9003 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9004 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9005 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9006 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9007 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9008 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9009 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9010 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9011 types and their arguments.
9012
9013 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9014 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9015 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9016 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9017
9018 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9019 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9020 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009021 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009022
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009023 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9024 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9025 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009026 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009027 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009028 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009029
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009030 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9031 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9032 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9033 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9034
9035 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9036 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9037 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9038 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9039 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9040 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9041
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009042 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9043 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9044 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9045 they were received.
9046
9047 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9048 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9049 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9050 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9051 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9052
9053 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9054 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9055 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9056 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9057 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9058
9059 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9060 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9061 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9062
9063 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9064 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9065 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9066 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9067 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9068
9069 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9070 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9071 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9072 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9073 the client side.
9074
9075 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9076 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9077 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9078 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9079 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9080 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9081 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9082
9083 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9084 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9085 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9086 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9087 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9088 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009089 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009090
9091 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9092 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9093 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9094 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9095 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9096 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9097
9098 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009099 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009100 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9101 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9102
9103 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9104 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9105 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9106 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9107 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9108 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9109 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9110 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9111 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9112 recommended for better fairness.
9113
9114 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009115 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009116 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9117 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9118
9119 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9120 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9121 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9122 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9123 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9124 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9125 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9126 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9127 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9128 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009129
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009130 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9131 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009132 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9133 reference it.
9134
9135 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9136 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009137 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9138 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9139 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009140
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009141 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9142 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9143 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9144 something that can be ignored.
9145
9146 Example:
9147 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9148 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9149 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9150 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9151
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009152 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009153 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009154
9155
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009156stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009157 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9159 no | no | yes | yes
9160
9161 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009162 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009163 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009164 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009165 server is selected.
9166
9167 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9168 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9169 the "stick-table" statement.
9170
9171 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9172 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9173 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9174 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9175
9176 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9177 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9178 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9179 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9180 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9181 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009182 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009183 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9184 rules.
9185
9186 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9187 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9188 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9189 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9190 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9191 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9192 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9193
9194 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9195 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9196 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9197 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9198
9199 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9200 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9201 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9202 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9203 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9204 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009205 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9206 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9207 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9208 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9209 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9210 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9211 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9212 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9213 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009214
9215 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9216
9217 Example :
9218 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9219 backend https
9220 mode tcp
9221 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009222 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009223 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009224
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009225 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9226 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9227
9228 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9229 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9230 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9231
9232 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9233 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009234
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009235 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9236 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9237 # at offset 44.
9238
9239 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9240 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9241
9242 # Learn on response if server hello.
9243 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009244
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009245 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9246 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9247
9248 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9249 extraction.
9250
9251
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009252tcp-check connect [params*]
9253 Opens a new connection
9254 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9255 no | no | yes | yes
9256
9257 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9258 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9259 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9260
9261 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9262 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9263 of the sequence.
9264
9265 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9266 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9267 do.
9268
9269 Parameters :
9270 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9271 use the TCP connection.
9272
9273 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9274 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9275 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9276
9277 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9278
9279 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9280
9281 Examples:
9282 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9283 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9284 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9285 option tcp-check
9286 tcp-check connect
9287 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9288 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9289 tcp-check send \r\n
9290 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9291 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9292 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9293 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9294 tcp-check send \r\n
9295 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9296 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9297
9298 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9299 option tcp-check
9300 tcp-check connect port 110
9301 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9302 tcp-check connect port 143
9303 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9304 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9305
9306 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9307
9308
9309tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009310 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009311 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9312 no | no | yes | yes
9313
9314 Arguments :
9315 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9316 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9317 binary.
9318 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9319 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9320 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9321
9322 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9323 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9324 with the usual backslash ('\').
9325 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009326 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009327 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9328 used upper or lower case.
9329
9330
9331 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9332
9333 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9334 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9335 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9336 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9337 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9338 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9339 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9340 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9341
9342 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9343 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9344 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9345 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9346 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9347 expression.
9348
9349 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9350 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9351 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9352 this exact hexadecimal string.
9353 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9354
9355 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9356 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9357 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9358 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9359 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9360 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9361 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9362 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9363 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9364 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9365 the null character.
9366
9367 Examples :
9368 # perform a POP check
9369 option tcp-check
9370 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9371
9372 # perform an IMAP check
9373 option tcp-check
9374 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9375
9376 # look for the redis master server
9377 option tcp-check
9378 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009379 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009380 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9381 tcp-check expect string role:master
9382 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9383 tcp-check expect string +OK
9384
9385
9386 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9387 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9388
9389
9390tcp-check send <data>
9391 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9392 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9393 no | no | yes | yes
9394
9395 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9396 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9397
9398 Examples :
9399 # look for the redis master server
9400 option tcp-check
9401 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9402 tcp-check expect string role:master
9403
9404 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9405 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9406
9407
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009408tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9409 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009410 tcp health check
9411 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9412 no | no | yes | yes
9413
9414 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9415 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009416 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009417 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9418 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9419 hexadecimal string.
9420 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9421
9422 Examples :
9423 # redis check in binary
9424 option tcp-check
9425 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9426 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9427
9428
9429 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9430 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9431
9432
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009433tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9434 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9436 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009437 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009438 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9439 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009440
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009441 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009442
9443 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9444 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009445 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9446 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9447 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9448 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9449 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9450 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009451
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009452 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9453 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9454 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9455 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009456
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009457 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009458 - accept :
9459 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9460 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9461 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009462
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009463 - reject :
9464 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9465 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9466 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9467 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9468 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9469 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9470 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9471 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9472 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9473 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9474 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009475 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009476
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009477 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9478 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9479 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9480 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9481 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9482 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9483 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9484 hosts.
9485
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009486 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9487 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9488 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9489 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9490 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9491 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9492 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9493 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9494
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009495 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9496 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9497 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9498 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9499 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9500 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9501 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9502 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9503 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009504 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9505 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009506
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009507 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009508 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009509 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9510 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9511 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9512 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9513 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9514 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9515 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9516 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9517 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9518 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9519 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9520 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009521
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009522 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009523 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009524 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009525 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009526 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9527 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9528 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009529
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009530 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9531 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9532 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9533 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009534
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009535 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9536 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9537 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9538 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9539 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009540 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9541 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9542 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9543 layer7 information is extracted.
9544
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009545 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9546 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9547 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9548 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9549 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009550
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009551 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9552 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9553 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9554 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9555
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009556 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9557 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9558 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9559 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9560
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009561 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9562 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9563 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9564 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9565 continues.
9566
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009567 - set-src <expr> :
9568 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9569 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9570 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009571 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009572
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009573 Arguments:
9574 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9575 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009576
9577 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009578 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9579
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009580 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9581 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009582
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009583 - set-src-port <expr> :
9584 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9585 expression.
9586
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009587 Arguments:
9588 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9589 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009590
9591 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009592 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9593
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009594 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9595 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9596 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009597
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009598 - set-dst <expr> :
9599 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9600 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9601 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9602 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9603 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9604
9605 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9606 followed by some converters.
9607
9608 Example:
9609
9610 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9611 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9612
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009613 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9614 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9615
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009616 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9617 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9618 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9619 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9620
9621
9622 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9623 followed by some converters.
9624
9625 Example:
9626
9627 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9628
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009629 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9630 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9631 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9632
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009633 - "silent-drop" :
9634 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009635 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009636 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9637 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9638 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9639 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9640 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009641 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9642 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009643 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9644 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009645 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009646 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9647 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9648 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9649 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9650
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009651 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9652 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9653 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009654
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009655 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9656 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9657 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009658
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009659 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009660 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009661 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009662
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009663 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9664 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9665 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009666
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009667 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009668 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9669 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009670
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009671 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9672
9673 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9674
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009675 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9676
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009677 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009678
9679
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009680tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9681 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009683 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009684 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009685 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9686 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009687
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009688 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009689
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009690 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009691 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9692 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9693 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9694 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009695
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009696 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9697 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9698 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9699 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009700 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9701 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9702 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9703 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9704 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9705 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009706 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009707 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009708
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009709 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9710 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9711 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9712 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009713
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009714 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009715 - accept : the request is accepted
9716 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9717 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009718 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009719 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009720 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009721 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009722 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009723 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009724 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009725 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009726 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009727
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009728 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9729 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009730
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009731 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9732 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9733 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9734 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9735 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9736 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009738 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009739 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9740 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009741
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009742 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009743 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9744 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9745 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9746 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009747 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9748 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9749 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009750
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009751 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009752 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9753 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9754 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009755
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009756 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009757 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9758 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009759
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009760 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9761 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009762 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009763 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9764 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009765 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009766 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009767 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009768 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9769 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009770 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009771 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9772 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009773
9774 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9775 followed by some converters.
9776
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009777 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9778 <var-name>.
9779
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009780 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9781 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9782 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9783 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9784 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9785
9786 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9787 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9788 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9789 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9790 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9791 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9792 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9793 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9794 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9795 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9796 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9797
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009798 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9799 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9800 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9801 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9802 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9803
9804 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9805
9806 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9807
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009808 Example:
9809
9810 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009811 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009812
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009813 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009814 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9815 # and reject everything else.
9816 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9817 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009818 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009819 tcp-request content reject
9820
9821 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009822 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9823 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9824 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009825 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009826
9827 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9828 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9829 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009830 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009831 tcp-request content reject
9832
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009833 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009834 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009835 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009836 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009837 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9838 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009839
9840 Example:
9841 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9842 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009843 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009844
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009845 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009846 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009847
9848 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009849 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009850 # protecting all our sites
9851 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009852 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9853 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009854 ...
9855 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9856
9857 backend http_dynamic
9858 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009859 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009860 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009861 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009862 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009863 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009864 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009866 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009867
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009868 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9869 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009870
9871
9872tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9873 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009875 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009876 Arguments :
9877 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9878 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9879 as explained at the top of this document.
9880
9881 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9882 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9883 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9884 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9885 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9886
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009887 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9888 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9889 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9890 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9891
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009892 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9893 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009894 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009895 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009896 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9897 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9898 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9899 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009900
9901 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9902 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9903 it pass through unaffected.
9904
9905 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9906 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9907 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009908 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009909 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9910 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009911 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9912 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9913 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009914
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009915 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009916 "timeout client".
9917
9918
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009919tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9920 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9922 no | no | yes | yes
9923 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009924 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9925 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009926
9927 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9928
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009929 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009930 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9931 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009932 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9933 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009934
9935 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9936
9937 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9938 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9939 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9940 inserted.
9941
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009942 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009943 - accept :
9944 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9945 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9946 the rules evaluation.
9947
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009948 - close :
9949 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9950 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9951 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9952 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9953 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9954 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009955 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009956 protocols.
9957
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009958 - reject :
9959 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9960 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009961 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009962
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009963 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9964 Sets a variable.
9965
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009966 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9967 Unsets a variable.
9968
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009969 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9970 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9971 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9972 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9973
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009974 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9975 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9976 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9977 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9978
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009979 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9980 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9981 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9982 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9983 continues.
9984
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009985 - "silent-drop" :
9986 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009987 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009988 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9989 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9990 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9991 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9992 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009993 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9994 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009995 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9996 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009997 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009998 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9999 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10000 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10001 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10002
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010003 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10004 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10005
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010006 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10007 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10008 for changing the default action to a reject.
10009
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010010 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10011 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10012 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10013 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010014 period.
10015
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010016 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10017 declared inline.
10018
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010019 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10020 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010021 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010022 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10023 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010024 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010025 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010026 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010027 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10028 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010029 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010030 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10031 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010032
10033 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10034 followed by some converters.
10035
10036 Example:
10037
10038 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10039
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010040 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10041 <var-name>.
10042
10043 Example:
10044
10045 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10046
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010047 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10048 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10049 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10050 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10051 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10052
10053 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10054
10055 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10056
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010057 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10058
10059 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10060
10061
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010062tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10063 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10065 no | yes | yes | no
10066 Arguments :
10067 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10068 below.
10069
10070 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10071
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010072 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010073 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10074 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10075 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10076 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10077 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10078 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10079 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010080 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010081 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10082 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10083 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10084 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10085 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10086 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10087 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10088 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10089 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10090 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10091 instead.
10092
10093 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10094 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10095 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10096 rules which may be inserted.
10097
10098 Several types of actions are supported :
10099 - accept : the request is accepted
10100 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10101 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10102 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010103 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010104 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10105 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010106 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010107 - silent-drop
10108
10109 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10110 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10111 sections for a complete description.
10112
10113 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10114 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10115 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10116
10117 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10118 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10119 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10120 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10121 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10122
10123 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10124 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10125
10126 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10127 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10128 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10129
10130 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10131 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10132 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10133
10134 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10135 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10136 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10137
10138 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10139 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10140 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10141
10142 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10143
10144 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10145
10146
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010147tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10148 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10150 no | no | yes | yes
10151 Arguments :
10152 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10153 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10154 as explained at the top of this document.
10155
10156 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10157
10158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010159timeout check <timeout>
10160 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10161 established.
10162
10163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10164 yes | no | yes | yes
10165 Arguments:
10166 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10167 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10168 as explained at the top of this document.
10169
10170 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10171 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010172 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010173 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010174 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10175 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10176 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010177
10178 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10179 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10180
10181 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10182 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010183 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010184
10185 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10186 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10187 forget about it.
10188
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010189 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10190 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010191
10192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010193timeout client <timeout>
10194timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10195 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10197 yes | yes | yes | no
10198 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010199 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010200 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10201 as explained at the top of this document.
10202
10203 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10204 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10205 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010206 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10207 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10208 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10209 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010210 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10211 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10212 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010213 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010214 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010215 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10216 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010217 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10218 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010219
10220 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10221 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10222 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10223 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10224 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10225 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10226
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010227 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010229 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10230 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10231 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10232
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010233 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10234 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010235
10236
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010237timeout client-fin <timeout>
10238 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10240 yes | yes | yes | no
10241 Arguments :
10242 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10243 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10244 as explained at the top of this document.
10245
10246 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10247 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10248 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10249 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10250 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10251 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10252 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010253 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10254 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10255 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010256
10257 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10258 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10259 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10260
10261 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10262
10263
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010264timeout connect <timeout>
10265timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10266 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10268 yes | no | yes | yes
10269 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010270 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010271 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10272 as explained at the top of this document.
10273
10274 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010275 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010276 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010277 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010278 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10279 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010280
10281 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10282 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10283 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10284 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10285 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10286 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10287
10288 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10289 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10290 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10291
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010292 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10293 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010294
10295
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010296timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10297 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10299 yes | yes | yes | yes
10300 Arguments :
10301 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10302 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10303 as explained at the top of this document.
10304
10305 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10306 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10307 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10308 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10309 once the request has started to present itself.
10310
10311 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10312 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10313 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10314 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10315 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10316
10317 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10318 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10319 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10320 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10321
10322 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10323 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010324 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010325 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10326 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010327 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010328
10329 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10330 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10331 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10332 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10333
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010334 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10335 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010336 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10337
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010338 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10339
10340
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010341timeout http-request <timeout>
10342 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010344 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010345 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010346 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010347 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10348 as explained at the top of this document.
10349
10350 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10351 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10352 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10353 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10354 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10355 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10356 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010357 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10358 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10359 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10360 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010361 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010362 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10363 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010364
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010365 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10366 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10367 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10368 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10369 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010370 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010371
10372 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10373 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010374 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010375 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10376 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10377
10378 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010379 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10380 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10381 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010382
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010383 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010384 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010385
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010386
10387timeout queue <timeout>
10388 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10390 yes | no | yes | yes
10391 Arguments :
10392 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10393 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10394 as explained at the top of this document.
10395
10396 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10397 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10398 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10399 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10400 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10401
10402 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10403 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10404 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10405 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10406
10407 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10408
10409
10410timeout server <timeout>
10411timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10412 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10414 yes | no | yes | yes
10415 Arguments :
10416 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10417 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10418 as explained at the top of this document.
10419
10420 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10421 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10422 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10423 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10424 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10425 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10426 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10427
10428 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10429 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10430 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10431 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10432 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010433 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010434 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010435 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10436 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010437 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10438 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010439
10440 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10441 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10442 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10443 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10444 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10445 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10446
10447 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10448 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10449 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10450
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010451 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010452
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010453
10454timeout server-fin <timeout>
10455 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10457 yes | no | yes | yes
10458 Arguments :
10459 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10460 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10461 as explained at the top of this document.
10462
10463 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10464 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10465 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10466 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10467 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10468 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10469 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10470 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10471 situations, it should not be needed.
10472
10473 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10474 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10475 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10476
10477 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10478
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010479
10480timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010481 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10483 yes | yes | yes | yes
10484 Arguments :
10485 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10486 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10487 as explained at the top of this document.
10488
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010489 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10490 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10491 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10492 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010493
10494 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10495 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10496 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10497 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010498 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010499
10500 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10501
10502
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010503timeout tunnel <timeout>
10504 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10506 yes | no | yes | yes
10507 Arguments :
10508 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10509 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10510 as explained at the top of this document.
10511
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010512 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010513 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10514 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10515 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010516 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10517 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010518 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10519 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10520 specified.
10521
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010522 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10523 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10524 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10525 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10526 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10527 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10528 state.
10529
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010530 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10531 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10532 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10533 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010534 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010535
10536 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10537 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10538 forget about it.
10539
10540 Example :
10541 defaults http
10542 option http-server-close
10543 timeout connect 5s
10544 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010545 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010546 timeout server 30s
10547 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10548
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010549 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010550
10551
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010552transparent (deprecated)
10553 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010555 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010556 Arguments : none
10557
10558 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10559 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10560 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10561 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10562 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10563 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10564 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10565 appropriate server.
10566
10567 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10568
10569 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10570 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10571
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010572 See also: "option transparent"
10573
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010574unique-id-format <string>
10575 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10577 yes | yes | yes | no
10578 Arguments :
10579 <string> is a log-format string.
10580
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010581 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10582 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10583 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10584 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010585
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010586 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10587 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10588 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10589 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10590 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10591 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10592 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10593 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010594
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010595 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10596 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010597
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010598 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010599
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010600 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010601
10602 will generate:
10603
10604 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10605
10606 See also: "unique-id-header"
10607
10608unique-id-header <name>
10609 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10611 yes | yes | yes | no
10612 Arguments :
10613 <name> is the name of the header.
10614
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010615 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10616 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010617
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010618 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010619
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010620 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010621 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10622
10623 will generate:
10624
10625 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10626
10627 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010628
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010629use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010630 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10632 no | yes | yes | no
10633 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010634 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10635 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010636
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010637 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10638 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010639
10640 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10641 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10642 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010643 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010644 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010645 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10646 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010647
10648 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10649 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10650 assign the backend.
10651
10652 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10653 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10654 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10655 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10656 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10657 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10658
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010659 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010660 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010661 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10662 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10663 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10664
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010665 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10666 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10667 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10668 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10669 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10670 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10671 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10672 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10673 cannot be forced from the request.
10674
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010675 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010676 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10677 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10678
10679 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10680 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010681
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010682
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010683use-server <server> if <condition>
10684use-server <server> unless <condition>
10685 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10687 no | no | yes | yes
10688 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010689 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010690
10691 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10692
10693 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10694 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10695 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10696
10697 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10698 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10699 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10700 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10701 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10702 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10703 matches will assign the server.
10704
10705 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10706 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10707 with the next rules until one matches.
10708
10709 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10710 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10711 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10712 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10713
10714 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10715 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10716 stripped.
10717
10718 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10719 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10720 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10721 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10722
10723 Example :
10724 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10725 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10726 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10727 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10728 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10729 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010730 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010731 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10732 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10733
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010734 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010735
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010736
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107375. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010738--------------------------
10739
10740The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10741depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10742settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10743written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10744described in this section.
10745
10746
107475.1. Bind options
10748-----------------
10749
10750The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10751as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10752no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10753parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10754while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10755provided immediately after the setting name.
10756
10757The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10758
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010759accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10760 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10761 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10762 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10763 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10764 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10765 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10766 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10767 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10768 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010769 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10770 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10771 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010772
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010773accept-proxy
10774 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010775 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10776 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010777 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10778 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10779 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10780 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010781 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010782 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10783 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010784 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10785 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010786
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010787allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010788 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010789 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10790 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10791 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10792 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010793
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010794alpn <protocols>
10795 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10796 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10797 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10798 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10799 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010800 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10801 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10802 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10803 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10804 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10805 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10806 preference, like below :
10807
10808 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010809
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010810backlog <backlog>
10811 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10812 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10813
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010814curves <curves>
10815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10816 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10817 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10818 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10819 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10820 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10821
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010822ecdhe <named curve>
10823 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010824 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10825 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010826
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010827ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10829 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10830 client's certificate.
10831
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010832ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10834 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10835 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10836 error is ignored.
10837
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010838ca-sign-file <cafile>
10839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10840 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10841 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10842 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10843 'generate-certificates' for details.
10844
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010845ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10847 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10848 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10849 'generate-certificates' for details.
10850
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010851ciphers <ciphers>
10852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10853 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010854 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3. The format of the
10855 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for
10856 instance a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without
10857 quotes). Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list
10858 of suitable ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background
10859 information and recommendations see e.g.
10860 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10861 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10862 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10863
10864ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10866 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10867 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10868 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
10869 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section, and can be for instance a
10870 string such as
10871 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
10872 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
10873 the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010874
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010875crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10877 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10878 to verify client's certificate.
10879
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010880crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10882 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10883 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10884 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10885 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10886 file.
10887
10888 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10889 are loaded.
10890
10891 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010892 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010893 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10894 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10895 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10896 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010897 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10898 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010899 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010900
10901 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10902 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10903 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10904 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010905 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10906 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010907
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010908 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010909
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010910 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010911 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010912 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10913 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010914 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10915 clients).
10916
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010917 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10918 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10919 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10920 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10921 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10922 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10923 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10924 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10925 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10926 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10927 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10928 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10929 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10930
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010931 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10932 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10933 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10934 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10935 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10936
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010937 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10938 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10939 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10940 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010941
10942 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10943 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10944 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10945 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10946 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10947 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10948 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10949 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10950 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10951
10952 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10953
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010954 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010955 a cert bundle.
10956
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010957 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010958 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10959 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10960 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10961 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10962 provide multi-cert support.
10963
10964 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10965
10966 Filename | CN | SAN
10967 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10968 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010969 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010970 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10971 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10972
10973 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10974 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10975 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10976 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010977 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10978 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10979 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010980
10981 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10982 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10983
10984 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10985 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10986 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10987
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010988crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010990 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010991 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010992 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010993
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010994crt-list <file>
10995 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010996 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10997 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010998
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010999 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11000
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011001 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11002 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011003 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011004 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011005
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011006 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11007 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11008 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11009 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11010 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11011 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11012 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11013 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011014
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011015 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011016 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011017 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11018 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11019 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011020
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011021 crt-list file example:
11022 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011023 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011024 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011025 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011026
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011027defer-accept
11028 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11029 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11030 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011031 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011032 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11033 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11034 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11035 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11036 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11037 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11038 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11039
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011040expose-fd listeners
11041 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11042 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011043 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11044 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011045 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011046
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011047force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011048 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011049 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011050 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011051 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011052
11053force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011054 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011055 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011056 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011057
11058force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011059 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011060 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011061 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011062
11063force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011064 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011065 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011066 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011067
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011068force-tlsv13
11069 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11070 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011071 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011072
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011073generate-certificates
11074 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11075 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11076 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11077 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11078 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11079 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11080 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11081 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11082 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11083 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11084 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11085
11086 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11087 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011088 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011089 certificate is used many times.
11090
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011091gid <gid>
11092 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11093 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11094 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11095 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11096 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11097
11098group <group>
11099 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11100 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11101 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11102 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11103 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11104
11105id <id>
11106 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11107 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11108 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11109 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11110
11111interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011112 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11113 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11114 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11115 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11116 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11117 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011118 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11119 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11120 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11121 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11122 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11123 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011124
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011125level <level>
11126 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11127 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11128 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011129 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011130 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11131 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11132 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011133 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011134 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011135 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011136 all counters).
11137
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011138severity-output <format>
11139 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11140 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11141 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11142 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11143 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11144 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11145 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11146 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11147 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11148 rfc5424 convention.
11149
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011150maxconn <maxconn>
11151 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11152 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11153 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11154 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11155 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11156 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11157 eat all memory.
11158
11159mode <mode>
11160 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11161 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11162 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11163 UNIX sockets.
11164
11165mss <maxseg>
11166 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11167 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11168 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11169 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11170 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11171 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11172 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11173 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11174 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11175 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11176 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11177
11178name <name>
11179 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11180 page.
11181
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011182namespace <name>
11183 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11184 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11185 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11186 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11187
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011188nice <nice>
11189 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11190 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11191 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11192 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11193 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11194 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11195 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11196 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11197 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11198 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11199 one for an RDP socket.
11200
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011201no-ca-names
11202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11203 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11204
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011205no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011206 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011207 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011208 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011209 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011210 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11211 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011212
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011213no-tls-tickets
11214 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11215 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11216 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011217 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11218 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011219
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011220no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011222 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011223 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011224 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011225 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11226 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011227
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011228no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011229 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011230 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011231 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011232 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011233 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11234 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011235
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011236no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011237 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011238 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011239 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011240 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011241 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11242 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011243
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011244no-tlsv13
11245 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11246 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11247 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11248 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011249 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11250 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011251
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011252npn <protocols>
11253 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11254 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11255 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11256 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011257 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011258 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11259 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11260 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11261 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11262 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011263
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011264prefer-client-ciphers
11265 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11266 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11267 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011268 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11269 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11270 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011271
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011272process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11273 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11274 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011275 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011276 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11277 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11278 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11279 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011280 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011281 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11282 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11283 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11284
11285 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11286
11287 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11288 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11289 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11290 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11291 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11292 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11293 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11294 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011295
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011296proto <name>
11297 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11298 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11299 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11300 in haproxy -vv.
11301 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11302 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011303 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011304 h2" on the bind line.
11305
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011306ssl
11307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011308 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011309 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11310 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011311 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11312 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011313
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011314ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11315 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11316 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11317 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11318
11319ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11320 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11321 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11322 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11323
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011324strict-sni
11325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11326 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11327 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11328 See the "crt" option for more information.
11329
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011330tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011331 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011332 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11333 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011334 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011335 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11336 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11337 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11338 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11339 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11340 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11341 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11342
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011343tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011344 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011345 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11346 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11347 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11348 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11349 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11350 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11351 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011352 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11353 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11354 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011355
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011356tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11357 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011358 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11359 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11360 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11361 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11362 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11363 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11364 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11365 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11366 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11367 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011368 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11369 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11370
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011371transparent
11372 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11373 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11374 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11375 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11376 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11377 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11378 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11379 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11380 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11381 so check for support with your vendor.
11382
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011383v4v6
11384 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11385 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11386 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11387 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011388 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011389
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011390v6only
11391 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11392 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11393 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011394 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11395 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011396
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011397uid <uid>
11398 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11399 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11400 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11401 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11402 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11403
11404user <user>
11405 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11406 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11407 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11408 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11409 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11410
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011411verify [none|optional|required]
11412 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11413 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11414 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11415 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11416 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011417 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11418 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11419 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11420 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011421
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114225.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011423------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011425The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11426which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11427arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11428settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11429after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11430Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11431address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011433 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011434 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011435
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011436Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11437keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011439The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011440
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011441addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011442 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011443 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11444 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11445 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11446 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11447 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011448
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011449agent-check
11450 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011451 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011452 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11453 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11454 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011455
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011456 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011457 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011458 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11459 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11460 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011461
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011462 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11463 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11464 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11465 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11466 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011467
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011468 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011469 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011470
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011471 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11472 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11473 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011474
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011475 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11476 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11477 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011478
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011479 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11480 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11481 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11482 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11483 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011484 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011485 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011486
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011487 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11488 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011489
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011490 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11491 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11492 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11493 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11494 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11495 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11496 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11497 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11498 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011499
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011500 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11501 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011502 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11503 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11504 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011505 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011506
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011507 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011508 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011509
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011510agent-send <string>
11511 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11512 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11513 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11514 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11515 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11516
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011517agent-inter <delay>
11518 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11519 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11520
11521 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11522 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11523 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11524 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11525 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11526 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11527 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11528 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11529 of backends use the same servers.
11530
11531 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11532
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011533agent-addr <addr>
11534 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11535
11536 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11537 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11538 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11539 hostname, it will be resolved.
11540
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011541agent-port <port>
11542 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11543
11544 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11545
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011546alpn <protocols>
11547 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11548 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11549 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11550 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11551 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11552 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11553 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11554 now obsolete NPN extension.
11555 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11556 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11557
11558 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011560backup
11561 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11562 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11563 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11564 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011565 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11566 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011567
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011568ca-file <cafile>
11569 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11570 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11571 server's certificate.
11572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011573check
11574 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011575 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11576 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11577 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11578 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11579 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11580 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11581 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011582 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11583 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011584 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11585 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011586
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011587check-send-proxy
11588 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11589 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11590 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11591 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11592 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11593 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11594 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11595
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011596check-alpn <protocols>
11597 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11598 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11599 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11600
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011601check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011602 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011603 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11604 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011605
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011606check-ssl
11607 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11608 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11609 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11610 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011611 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011612 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11613 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011614 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011615 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11616 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011617
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011618ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11620 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11621 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011622 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11623 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11624 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11625 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11626 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11627 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11628
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011629ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11630 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11631 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11632 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11633 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
11634 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section.
11635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011636cookie <value>
11637 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11638 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11639 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11640 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11641 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11642 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11643 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11644
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011645crl-file <crlfile>
11646 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11647 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11648 to verify server's certificate.
11649
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011650crt <cert>
11651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11652 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11653 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11654 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11655 certificate request.
11656
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011657disabled
11658 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11659 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11660 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11661 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11662 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011663 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011664
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011665enabled
11666 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11667 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11668 default value.
11669 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11670 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011672error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011673 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11674 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11675 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011677 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011679fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011680 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11681 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11682 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11683
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011684force-sslv3
11685 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11686 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011687 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011688 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011689
11690force-tlsv10
11691 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011692 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011693 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011694
11695force-tlsv11
11696 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011697 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011698 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011699
11700force-tlsv12
11701 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011702 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011703 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011704
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011705force-tlsv13
11706 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11707 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011708 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011710id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011711 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11712 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11713 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011714
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011715init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11716 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11717 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011718 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011719 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11720 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11721 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11722 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11723 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11724 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11725 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11726 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11727 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011728 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011729 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11730 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11731 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11732 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11733 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11734 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011735 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011736
11737 Example:
11738 defaults
11739 # never fail on address resolution
11740 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011742inter <delay>
11743fastinter <delay>
11744downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011745 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11746 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11747 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11748 between checks depending on the server state :
11749
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011750 Server state | Interval used
11751 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11752 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11753 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11754 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11755 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11756 or yet unchecked. |
11757 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11758 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11759 | "inter" otherwise.
11760 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011762 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11763 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11764 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11765 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011766 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11767 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11768 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11769 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11770 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011772maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011773 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11774 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11775 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11776 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11777 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11778 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11779 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11780 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011782maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011783 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11784 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11785 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11786 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11787 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11788 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11789 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011791minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011792 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11793 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11794 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11795 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11796 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11797 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011798 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011799 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011800
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011801namespace <name>
11802 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11803 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11804 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11805 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11806
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011807no-agent-check
11808 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11809 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11810 default value.
11811 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11812 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11813
11814no-backup
11815 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11816 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11817 default value.
11818 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11819 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11820
11821no-check
11822 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11823 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11824 default value.
11825 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11826 "default-server" "check" setting.
11827
11828no-check-ssl
11829 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11830 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11831 default value.
11832 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11833 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11834
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011835no-send-proxy
11836 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11837 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11838 default value.
11839 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11840 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11841
11842no-send-proxy-v2
11843 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11844 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11845 default value.
11846 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11847 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11848
11849no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11850 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11851 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11852 default value.
11853 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11854 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11855
11856no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11857 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11858 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11859 default value.
11860 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11861 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11862
11863no-ssl
11864 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11865 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11866 default value.
11867 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11868 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11869
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011870no-ssl-reuse
11871 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11872 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11873 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11874 and for paranoid users.
11875
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011876no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011877 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11878 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011879 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011880
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011881 Supported in default-server: No
11882
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011883no-tls-tickets
11884 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11885 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11886 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011887 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11888 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011889 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011890
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011891no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011892 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011893 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11894 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011895 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11896 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011897 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011898
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011899 Supported in default-server: No
11900
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011901no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011902 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011903 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11904 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011905 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11906 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011907 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011908
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011909 Supported in default-server: No
11910
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011911no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011912 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011913 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11914 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011915 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11916 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011917 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011918
11919 Supported in default-server: No
11920
11921no-tlsv13
11922 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11923 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11924 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11925 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11926 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011927 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011928
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011929 Supported in default-server: No
11930
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011931no-verifyhost
11932 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11933 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11934 default value.
11935 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11936 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011937
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011938non-stick
11939 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11940 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11941 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11942
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011943npn <protocols>
11944 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11945 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11946 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11947 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11948 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11949 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11950 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11951
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011952observe <mode>
11953 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11954 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11955 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11956 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11957 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11958 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011959 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011960
11961 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011963on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011964 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11965 Currently, four modes are available:
11966 - fastinter: force fastinter
11967 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11968 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11969 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11970 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11971
11972 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11973
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011974on-marked-down <action>
11975 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11976 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011977 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11978 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11979 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11980 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11981 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11982 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11983 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11984 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011985
11986 Actions are disabled by default
11987
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011988on-marked-up <action>
11989 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11990 Currently one action is available:
11991 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11992 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11993 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11994 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011995 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11996 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011997 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11998 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11999
12000 Actions are disabled by default
12001
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012002pool-max-conn <max>
12003 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12004 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12005 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12006 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12007 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12008 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12009
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012010pool-purge-delay <delay>
12011 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
12012 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means it's never purged. The default is
12013 1s.
12014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012015port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012016 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12017 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12018 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12019 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12020 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12021 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12022
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012023proto <name>
12024
12025 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12026 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12027 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12028 reported in haproxy -vv.
12029 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12030 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012032redir <prefix>
12033 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12034 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12035 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12036 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12037 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12038 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12039 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12040 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012041 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012042 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012043 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12044 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12045 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12046 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12047
12048 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012050rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012051 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12052 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12053 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12054
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012055resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12056 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12057 server.
12058
12059 Available options:
12060
12061 * allow-dup-ip
12062 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12063 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12064 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12065 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12066 For such case, simply enable this option.
12067 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12068
12069 * prevent-dup-ip
12070 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12071 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12072 same fqdn.
12073 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12074
12075 Example:
12076 backend b_myapp
12077 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12078 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12079 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12080
12081 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12082 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12083 it
12084 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12085 different address
12086
12087 Default value: not set
12088
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012089resolve-prefer <family>
12090 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12091 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12092 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12093 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12094
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012095 Default value: ipv6
12096
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012097 Example:
12098
12099 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012100
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012101resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12102 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12103 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012104 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012105 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12106 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012107 configured network, another address is selected.
12108
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012109 Example:
12110
12111 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012112
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012113resolvers <id>
12114 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12115 hostname.
12116
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012117 Example:
12118
12119 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012120
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012121 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012122
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012123send-proxy
12124 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12125 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12126 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12127 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012128 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12129 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12130 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12131 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12132 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12133 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12134 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12135 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12136 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12137 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012138 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12139 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012140
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012141send-proxy-v2
12142 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12143 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12144 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12145 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012146 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12147 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12148 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12149 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012150
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012151proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12152 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12153 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012154 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12155 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012156 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12157 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012158 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012159
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012160send-proxy-v2-ssl
12161 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12162 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12163 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12164 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12165 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12166 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12167 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012168 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12169 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012170
12171send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12172 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12173 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12174 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12175 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12176 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12177 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12178 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12179 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012180 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12181 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012183slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012184 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12185 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12186 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12187 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12188 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12189 parameters :
12190
12191 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12192 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12193
12194 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12195 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12196 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12197 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12198
12199 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12200 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12201 seen as failed.
12202
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012203sni <expression>
12204 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12205 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12206 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12207 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012208 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12209 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012210 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012211 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12212 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012213
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012214source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012215source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012216source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012217 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12218 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12219 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12220 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12221
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012222 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12223 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12224 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12225 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12226 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12227 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12228 server.
12229
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012230 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12231 specifying the source address without port(s).
12232
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012233ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012234 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12235 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12236 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12237 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12238 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12239 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012240 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12241 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012242
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012243ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12244 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12245 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12246 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12247
12248ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12249 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12250 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12251 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12252
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012253ssl-reuse
12254 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12255 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12256 default value.
12257 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12258 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12259
12260stick
12261 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12262 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12263 default value.
12264 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12265 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012266
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012267tcp-ut <delay>
12268 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12269 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12270 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012271 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012272 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12273 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12274 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12275 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12276 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12277 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12278 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12279 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12280 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012282track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012283 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12284 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12285 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12286 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012287 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12288
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012289tls-tickets
12290 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12291 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12292 default value.
12293 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12294 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012295
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012296verify [none|required]
12297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012298 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012299 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12300 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012301 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012302 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12303 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12304 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12305 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12306 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12307 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12308 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12309 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012310
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012311verifyhost <hostname>
12312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012313 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12314 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12315 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12316 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12317 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12318 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12319 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12320 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012322weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012323 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12324 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12325 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012326 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12327 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12328 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12329 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12330 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12331 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012332
12333
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123345.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12335-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012336
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012337HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12338using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12339configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012340This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12341can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12342workload.
12343This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12344resolution at run time.
12345Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12346carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12347
12348
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123495.3.1. Global overview
12350----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012351
12352As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12353different steps of the process life:
12354
12355 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12356 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12357 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12358
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012359 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12360 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012361
12362A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12363 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12364 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12365 resolution to know this new IP.
12366
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012367When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012368HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012369SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12370from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12371will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12372will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012373
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012374A few things important to notice:
12375 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12376 first valid response.
12377
12378 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12379 servers return an error.
12380
12381
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123825.3.2. The resolvers section
12383----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012384
12385This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012386HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12387contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012388
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012389When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12390uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12391is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12392answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12393
12394When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012395used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012396
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012397 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12398 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12399 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012400
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012401 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12402 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012403
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012404 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12405 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12406 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012407
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012408For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12409following scenarios are possible:
12410
12411 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12412 ignored
12413
12414 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12415 applied
12416
12417 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12418 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12419
12420 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12421 retries the query with a new type
12422
12423 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12424 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012425
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012426As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12427a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012428<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012429
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012430
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012431resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012432 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012433
12434A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12435
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012436accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012437 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012438 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012439 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12440 by RFC 6891)
12441
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012442 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12443
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012444nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12445 DNS server description:
12446 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12447 <ip> : IP address of the server
12448 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12449
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012450parse-resolv-conf
12451 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12452 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12453 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12454
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012455hold <status> <period>
12456 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12457 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012458 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012459 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012460 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12461 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12462 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12463
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012464 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012465
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012466resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012467 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12468 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12469 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12470
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012471resolve_retries <nb>
12472 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12473 giving up.
12474 Default value: 3
12475
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012476 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12477 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12478 type.
12479
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012480timeout <event> <time>
12481 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12482 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12483 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012484 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12485 other time applied.
12486 Default value: 1s
12487 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12488 have been received.
12489 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012490 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12491 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12492
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012493 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012494
12495 resolvers mydns
12496 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12497 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012498 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012499 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012500 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012501 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012502 hold other 30s
12503 hold refused 30s
12504 hold nx 30s
12505 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012506 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012507 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012508
12509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125106. HTTP header manipulation
12511---------------------------
12512
12513In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12514response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12515request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12516which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012517against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012518
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012519If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12520to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12521but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12522HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12523stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12524because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12525a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12526still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012528This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12529in section 4.2 :
12530
12531 - reqadd <string>
12532 - reqallow <search>
12533 - reqiallow <search>
12534 - reqdel <search>
12535 - reqidel <search>
12536 - reqdeny <search>
12537 - reqideny <search>
12538 - reqpass <search>
12539 - reqipass <search>
12540 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12541 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12542 - reqtarpit <search>
12543 - reqitarpit <search>
12544 - rspadd <string>
12545 - rspdel <search>
12546 - rspidel <search>
12547 - rspdeny <search>
12548 - rspideny <search>
12549 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12550 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12551
12552With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12553is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12554parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12555prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12556Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12557
12558 \t for a tab
12559 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12560 \n for a new line (LF)
12561 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12562 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12563 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12564 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12565 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12566
12567The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12568portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12569above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12570regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
125719 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12572is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12573
12574The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12575after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12576
12577Notes related to these keywords :
12578---------------------------------
12579 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12580 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12581 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12582
12583 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12584 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12585 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12586
12587 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12588 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12589 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12590 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12591 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12592
12593 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12594 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12595 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12596 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12597 useless headers before adding new ones.
12598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012599 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012600 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12601
12602 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12603 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12604 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12605
12606 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12607 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012608 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012609
12610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126117. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12612----------------------------------
12613
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012614HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012615client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12616The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12617these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12618but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12619data called patterns.
12620
12621
126227.1. ACL basics
12623---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012624
12625The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12626content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12627from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12628simple :
12629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012630 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012631 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012632 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12633 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012635The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12636adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012637
12638In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012640 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012641
12642This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12643Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12644and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012645an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12646conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12647as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12648are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012649
12650ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12651'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12652which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12653
12654There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12655performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012657The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12658specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12659this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012660methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12661ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012662
12663Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12664 - boolean
12665 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12666 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12667 - string
12668 - data block
12669
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012670Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12671converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12672would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12673The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12674which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12675
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012676Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12677keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12678fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12679which are summarized in the table below :
12680
12681 +---------------------+-----------------+
12682 | Sample or converter | Default |
12683 | output type | matching method |
12684 +---------------------+-----------------+
12685 | boolean | bool |
12686 +---------------------+-----------------+
12687 | integer | int |
12688 +---------------------+-----------------+
12689 | ip | ip |
12690 +---------------------+-----------------+
12691 | string | str |
12692 +---------------------+-----------------+
12693 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12694 +---------------------+-----------------+
12695
12696Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12697matching method, see below.
12698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012699The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12700 - boolean
12701 - integer or integer range
12702 - IP address / network
12703 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12704 - regular expression
12705 - hex block
12706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012707The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12708
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012709 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12710 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012711 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012712 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012713 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012714 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012715 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012717The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12718read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12719if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12720lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12721will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12722beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12723a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12724lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12725exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12726
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012727The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12728parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12729ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12730a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12731check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12732
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012733The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12734socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12735file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012737Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12738loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12739
12740 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12741
12742In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12743the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12744case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12745as well.
12746
12747The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12748sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12749do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12750methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12751is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012752obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012753followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12754default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12755that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12756string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12757
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012758The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12759By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12760string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12761resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12762server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12763waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12764flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12765function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012767There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12768sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12769be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012770
12771 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12772 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012773 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12774 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12775 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12776 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012777
12778 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12779 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012780 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012781
12782 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012783 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012784
12785 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012786 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012787
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012788 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012789 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12790
12791 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12792 binary or string samples.
12793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012794 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12795 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012797 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12798 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12799 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012801 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12802 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012804 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12805 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012807 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12808 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012810 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12811 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012812 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012814 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12815 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12816 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012817
12818For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12819request, it is possible to do :
12820
12821 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12822
12823In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12824buffer, one would use the following acl :
12825
12826 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12827
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012828On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12829possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12830
12831 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12834criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12835method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12836to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12837criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12838the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012840If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012841the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12842For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012844 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12845 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12846 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12847 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012848
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012849
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012850The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12851types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12852combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12853brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12854default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012856 +-------------------------------------------------+
12857 | Input sample type |
12858 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012859 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012860 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12861 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12862 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012863 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012865 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012866 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012867 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012869 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012871 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012873 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012875 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012877 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012879 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012881 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012883 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12885 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12886 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012887
12888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128897.1.1. Matching booleans
12890------------------------
12891
12892In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12893Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12894When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12895that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12896
12897Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12898return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12899"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12900
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129027.1.2. Matching integers
12903------------------------
12904
12905Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12906enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12907to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12908
12909Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12910matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12911lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012912
12913For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12914unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12915representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12916
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012917As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12918two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12919instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12920ranges and operators.
12921
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012922For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012923operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12924Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12925of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012926
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012927Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012928
12929 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12930 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12931 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12932 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12933 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012935For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012936
12937 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12938
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012939This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12940
12941 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12942
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129447.1.3. Matching strings
12945-----------------------
12946
12947String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12948different forms :
12949
12950 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012951 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012952
12953 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012954 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012955
12956 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12957 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12958
12959 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12960 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12961
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012962 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012963 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12964 matches.
12965
12966 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12967 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12968 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012969
12970String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12971exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12972characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12973string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12974to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012975before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012976
12977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129787.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12979---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012980
12981Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12982they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12983possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12984passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12985the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012986the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12987match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012988
12989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129907.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12991-------------------------------------
12992
12993It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12994not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12995a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12996to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12997digits may be used upper or lower case.
12998
12999Example :
13000 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13001 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13002
13003
130047.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13005---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013006
13007IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13008netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13009within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013010host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013011difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13012at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13013does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13014parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013015
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013016The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13017abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13018
13019 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13020 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13021 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13022 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13023 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13024 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13025 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13026 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13027
13028Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13029192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13030
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013031IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13032Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13033trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13034IPv6 patterns.
13035
13036HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13037following situations :
13038 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13039 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13040 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13041 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13042 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13043 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13044 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13045 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13046 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13047 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013049
130507.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13051----------------------------------
13052
13053Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13054combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13055
13056 - AND (implicit)
13057 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13058 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013064Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13065indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013067For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13068"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13069requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13070is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13071
13072 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013073 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13074 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13075 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013076
13077To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13078and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13079
13080 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13081 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13082 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13083 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13084
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013085 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013086 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13087 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13088 use_backend www if host_www
13089
13090It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13091expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13092be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13093the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13094
13095 The following rule :
13096
13097 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013098 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013099
13100 Can also be written that way :
13101
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013102 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013103
13104It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13105to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13106simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13107sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13108good use is the following :
13109
13110 With named ACLs :
13111
13112 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13113 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13114 monitor fail if site_dead
13115
13116 With anonymous ACLs :
13117
13118 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13119
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013120See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13121keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013122
13123
131247.3. Fetching samples
13125---------------------
13126
13127Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13128against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13129sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13130ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13131of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13132available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13133
13134This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13135Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13136compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13137deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13138
13139The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13140matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13141method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13142indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13143
13144As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13145when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13146mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13147the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13148ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13149
13150Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13151multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13152when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013153incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13154are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013155is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13156all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13157
13158Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13159 - name
13160 - name(arg1)
13161 - name(arg1,arg2)
13162
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013163
131647.3.1. Converters
13165-----------------
13166
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013167Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13168of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13169is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13170was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013171has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013172unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13173
13174These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13175sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13176the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013177support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013178
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013179A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13180support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13181supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13182(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13183bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013185The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013186
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001318751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13188 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13189 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13190 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13191 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13192 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13193
13194 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013195 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13196 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013197 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13198 frontend http-in
13199 bind *:8081
13200 default_backend servers
13201 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13202 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13203
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013204add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013205 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013206 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013207 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13208 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013209 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013210 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13211 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13212 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13213 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013214 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013215 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013216
13217and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013218 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013219 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013220 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13221 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013222 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013223 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13224 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13225 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13226 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013227 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013228 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013229
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013230b64dec
13231 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13232 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13233
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013234base64
13235 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013236 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013237 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13238
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013239bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013240 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013241 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013242 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013243 presence of a flag).
13244
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013245bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13246 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13247 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013248 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013249
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013250concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13251 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13252 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13253 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13254 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13255 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13256 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13257 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13258 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13259 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13260 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13261 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13262 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13263 delimitors.
13264
13265 Example:
13266 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13267 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13268 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13269 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13270
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013271cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013272 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13273 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013274
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013275crc32([<avalanche>])
13276 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13277 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13278 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13279 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13280 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13281 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13282 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13283 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13284 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13285 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013286 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13287
13288crc32c([<avalanche>])
13289 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13290 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13291 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13292 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13293 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13294 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13295 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13296 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013297
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013298da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013299 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13300 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13301 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13302 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013303 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013304 configuration language.
13305
13306 Example:
13307 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013308 bind *:8881
13309 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013310 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013311
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013312debug
13313 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13314 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13315 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13316
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013317div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013318 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13319 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013320 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013321 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13322 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013323 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013324 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13325 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13326 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13327 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013328 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013329 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013330
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013331djb2([<avalanche>])
13332 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13333 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13334 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13335 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13336 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13337 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13338 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013339 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13340 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013341
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013342even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013343 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013344 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13345
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013346field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13347 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13348 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13349 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13350 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13351 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13352 fields.
13353
13354 Example :
13355 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13356 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13357 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13358 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13359 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013360
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013361hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013362 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013363 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013364 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013365 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013366
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013367hex2i
13368 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13369 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13370
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013371http_date([<offset>])
13372 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13373 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13374 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13375 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13376 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13377 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013378
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013379in_table(<table>)
13380 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13381 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13382 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013383 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013384 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13385
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013386ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13387 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013388 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013389 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13390 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13391 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13392 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13393 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013394
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013395json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013396 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013397 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013398 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013399 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13400 of errors:
13401 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13402 bytes, ...)
13403 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13404 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13405
13406 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13407 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13408 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13409 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13410 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13411 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013412 - "ascii" : never fails;
13413 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13414 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013415 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013416 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013417 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13418 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13419
13420 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013421 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013422
13423 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013424 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013425 capture request header user-agent len 150
13426 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013427
13428 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13429 GET / HTTP/1.0
13430 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13431
13432 Output log:
13433 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13434
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013435language(<value>[,<default>])
13436 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13437 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13438 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13439 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13440 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13441 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13442 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13443 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13444 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013445 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013446 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13447 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013448
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013449 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013450
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013451 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13452 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013453
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013454 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13455 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13456 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13457 use_backend spanish if es
13458 use_backend french if fr
13459 use_backend english if en
13460 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013461
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013462length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013463 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13464 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13465 type. The result is of type integer.
13466
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013467lower
13468 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13469 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13470 type. The result is of type string.
13471
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013472ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13473 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13474 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13475 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13476 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13477 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13478 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13479
13480 Example :
13481
13482 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013483 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013484 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13485
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013486map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13487map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13488map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13489 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13490 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13491 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13492 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13493 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13494 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13495 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13496 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013497
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013498 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13499 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13500 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013501
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013502 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013503 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013504
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013505 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13506 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13507 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13508 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013509 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13510 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013511 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13512 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13513 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13514 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13515 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13516 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13517 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13518 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013519 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13520 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13521 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013522 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13523 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13524 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13525 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13526 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013527
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013528 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13529 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13530 the corresponding match text.
13531
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013532 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13533 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13534 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13535 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13536 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013537
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013538 Example :
13539
13540 # this is a comment and is ignored
13541 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13542 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13543 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13544 | | | `---------- value
13545 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13546 | `---------------------------- key
13547 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13548
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013549mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013550 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13551 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013552 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013553 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013554 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013555 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13556 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13557 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13558 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013559 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013560 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013561
13562mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013563 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013564 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13565 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013566 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013567 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013568 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013569 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13570 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13571 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13572 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013573 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013574 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013575
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013576nbsrv
13577 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13578 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13579 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13580 map lookup.
13581
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013582neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013583 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13584 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13585 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13586 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013587
13588not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013589 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013590 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013591 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013592 absence of a flag).
13593
13594odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013595 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013596 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13597
13598or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013599 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013600 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013601 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13602 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013603 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013604 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13605 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13606 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13607 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013608 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013609 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013610
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013611regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013612 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13613 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13614 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13615 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13616 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13617 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13618 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13619 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13620 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13621 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013622 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13623 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13624 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13625 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013626
13627 Example :
13628
13629 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13630 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13631 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13632 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13633
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013634capture-req(<id>)
13635 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13636 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13637
13638 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013639 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13640 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013641
13642capture-res(<id>)
13643 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13644 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13645
13646 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013647 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13648 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013649
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013650sdbm([<avalanche>])
13651 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13652 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13653 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13654 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13655 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13656 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13657 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013658 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13659 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013660
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013661set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013662 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13663 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13664 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013665 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013666 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13667 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013668 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013669 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13670 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013671 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013672 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013673
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013674sha1
13675 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13676 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13677
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013678strcmp(<var>)
13679 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13680 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13681 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13682 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13683 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13684 shorter).
13685
13686 Example :
13687
13688 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13689 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13690 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13691
13692
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013693sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013694 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13695 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013696 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013697 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13698 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013699 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013700 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13701 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013702 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013703 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13704 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013705 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013706 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013707
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013708table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13709 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13710 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13711 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13712 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13713 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13714 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13715
13716
13717table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13718 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13719 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13720 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13721 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13722 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13723 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13724
13725table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13726 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13727 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013728 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013729 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13730 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13731
13732table_conn_cur(<table>)
13733 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13734 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13735 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13736 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13737 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13738
13739table_conn_rate(<table>)
13740 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13741 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13742 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13743 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13744 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13745
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013746table_gpt0(<table>)
13747 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13748 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13749 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13750 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13751 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13752
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013753table_gpc0(<table>)
13754 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13755 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13756 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13757 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13758 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13759
13760table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13761 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13762 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13763 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13764 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13765 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13766 sample fetch keyword.
13767
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013768table_gpc1(<table>)
13769 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13770 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13771 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13772 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13773 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13774
13775table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13776 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13777 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13778 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13779 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13780 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13781 sample fetch keyword.
13782
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013783table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13784 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13785 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013786 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013787 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13788 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13789
13790table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13791 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13792 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13793 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13794 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13795 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13796 keyword.
13797
13798table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13799 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13800 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013801 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013802 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13803 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13804
13805table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13806 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13807 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13808 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13809 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13810 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13811 keyword.
13812
13813table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13814 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13815 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013816 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013817 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13818 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13819 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13820 keyword.
13821
13822table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13823 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13824 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013825 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013826 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13827 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13828 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13829 keyword.
13830
13831table_server_id(<table>)
13832 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13833 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13834 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13835 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13836 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13837 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13838
13839table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13840 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13841 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013842 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013843 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13844 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13845 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13846 keyword.
13847
13848table_sess_rate(<table>)
13849 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13850 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13851 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13852 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13853 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13854 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13855 keyword.
13856
13857table_trackers(<table>)
13858 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13859 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13860 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13861 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13862 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13863 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13864 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13865 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13866 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13867 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13868
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013869upper
13870 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13871 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13872 type. The result is of type string.
13873
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013874url_dec
13875 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13876 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13877
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013878unset-var(<var name>)
13879 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13880 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13881 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13882 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13883 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13884 response),
13885 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13886 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13887 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13888 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13889
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013890utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13891 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13892 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13893 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13894 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13895 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13896 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13897
13898 Example :
13899
13900 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013901 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013902 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13903
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013904word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13905 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13906 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13907 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13908 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13909 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13910
13911 Example :
13912 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13913 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13914 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13915 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13916 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013917
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013918wt6([<avalanche>])
13919 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13920 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13921 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13922 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13923 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13924 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13925 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013926 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13927 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013928
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013929xor(<value>)
13930 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013931 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013932 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013933 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013934 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013935 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13936 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013937 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013938 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13939 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013940 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013941 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013942
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013943xxh32([<seed>])
13944 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13945 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13946 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13947 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13948 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13949 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13950 as cryptographically secure.
13951
13952xxh64([<seed>])
13953 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13954 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13955 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13956 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13957 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13958 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13959 as cryptographically secure.
13960
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013961
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139627.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013963--------------------------------------------
13964
13965A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13966not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13967"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13968The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13969
13970always_false : boolean
13971 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13972 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13973
13974always_true : boolean
13975 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13976 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13977
13978avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013979 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013980 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13981 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13982 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13983 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13984 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13985 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13986 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13987 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13988 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13989 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13990 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13991 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13992 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013994be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013995 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13996 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13997 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13998 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013999 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14000
14001be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14002 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14003 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14004 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14005 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14006 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014007 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14008 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014009
14010 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14011 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14012 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014014be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14015 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14016 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14017 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014018 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014019 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14020 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014021
14022 Example :
14023 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14024 backend dynamic
14025 mode http
14026 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14027 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014028
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014029bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014030 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14031 of the string.
14032
14033bool(<bool>) : bool
14034 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14035 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014037connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14038 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014039 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014040 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14041 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014042
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014043 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014044 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014045 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14046
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014047 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14048 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014049
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014050 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014051 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014052 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014053 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014054 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014055 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014056 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014057
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014058 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14059 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014060 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014061 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014062
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014063cpu_calls : integer
14064 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14065 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14066 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14067 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14068 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14069 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14070
14071cpu_ns_avg : integer
14072 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14073 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14074 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14075 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14076 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14077 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14078 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14079 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14080 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14081 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14082 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14083
14084cpu_ns_tot : integer
14085 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14086 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14087 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14088 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14089 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14090 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14091 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14092 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14093 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14094 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14095 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14096 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14097 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14098
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014099date([<offset>]) : integer
14100 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14101 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14102 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14103 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014104 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14105
14106 Example :
14107
14108 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14109 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014110
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014111date_us : integer
14112 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14113 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14114 from the same timeval structure.
14115
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014116distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14117 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14118 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14119 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14120 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14121 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14122 list of supported tokens.
14123
14124distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14125 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14126 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14127 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14128 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14129 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14130 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14131 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14132 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14133 supported tokens.
14134
14135 Example :
14136 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14137 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14138 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14139 # send large files to the big farm
14140 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14141
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014142env(<name>) : string
14143 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14144 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14145 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14146 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14147 certain way.
14148
14149 Examples :
14150 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14151 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14152
14153 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14154 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014156fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14157 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014158 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14159 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014160 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14161 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014162 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014163 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14164 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014165
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014166fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14167 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14168 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14169 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014171fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14172 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14173 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14174 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14175 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14176 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14177 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14178 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14179 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014180
14181 Example :
14182 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14183 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14184 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14185 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14186 frontend mail
14187 bind :25
14188 mode tcp
14189 maxconn 100
14190 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14191 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14192 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14193 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014194
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014195hostname : string
14196 Returns the system hostname.
14197
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014198int(<integer>) : signed integer
14199 Returns a signed integer.
14200
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014201ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14202 Returns an ipv4.
14203
14204ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14205 Returns an ipv6.
14206
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014207lat_ns_avg : integer
14208 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14209 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14210 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14211 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14212 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14213 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14214 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14215 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14216 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14217 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14218 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14219 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14220 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14221 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14222
14223lat_ns_tot : integer
14224 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14225 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14226 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14227 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14228 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14229 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14230 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14231 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14232 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14233 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14234 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14235 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14236 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14237 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14238 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14239 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14240 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14241 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14242 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14243
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014244meth(<method>) : method
14245 Returns a method.
14246
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014247nbproc : integer
14248 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14249 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14250 and debugging purposes.
14251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014252nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14253 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14254 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14255 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014256 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14257 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14258 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014259
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014260prio_class : integer
14261 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14262 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14263 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14264
14265prio_offset : integer
14266 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14267 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14268 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14269 set-priority-offset".
14270
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014271proc : integer
14272 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14273 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14274 debugging purposes.
14275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014276queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014277 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14278 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14279 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014280 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14281 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14282 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14283 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14284 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14285
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014286rand([<range>]) : integer
14287 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14288 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14289 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14290 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14291 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014293srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14294 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14295 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14296 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14297 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14298 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014299 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14300 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14301
14302srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14303 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14304 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14305 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14306 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14307 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14308 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14309 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14310
14311 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14312 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014313
14314srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14315 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14316 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14317 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014318 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014319 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14320 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14321 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14322
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014323srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14324 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14325 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14326 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14327 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14328 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14329 fetch methods.
14330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14332 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14333 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014334 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014335 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14336 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014337 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338 overloading servers).
14339
14340 Example :
14341 # Redirect to a separate back
14342 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14343 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14344 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14345
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014346stopping : boolean
14347 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14348 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14349 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14350
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014351str(<string>) : string
14352 Returns a string.
14353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014354table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14355 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14356 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14357
14358table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14359 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14360 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14361 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14362
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014363thread : integer
14364 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14365 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14366 and debugging purposes.
14367
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014368var(<var-name>) : undefined
14369 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014370 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14371 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014372 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014373 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14374 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014375 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014376 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14377 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014378 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014379 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014380
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014382----------------------------------
14383
14384The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14385closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14386methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14387sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14388TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014389the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14390counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014391"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14392used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14393can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14394Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14395table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14396tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14397currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014399bc_http_major: integer
14400 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14401 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14402 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014404be_id : integer
14405 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14406 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14407
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014408be_name : string
14409 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14410 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014412dst : ip
14413 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14414 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14415 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14416 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
14417 RFC 4291.
14418
14419dst_conn : integer
14420 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14421 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14422 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14423 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14424 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14425 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14426 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14427 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014428
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014429dst_is_local : boolean
14430 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14431 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14432 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14433 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014434 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014435 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14436 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14437 it only once per connection.
14438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014439dst_port : integer
14440 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14441 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14442 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14443 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14444 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14445 an HTTP header.
14446
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014447fc_http_major : integer
14448 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14449 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14450 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14451
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014452fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14453 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14454 header.
14455
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014456fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14457 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14458 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14459 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14460 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14461 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14462 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14463
14464fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14465 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14466 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14467 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14468 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14469 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14470 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14471
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014472fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14473 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14474 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14475 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14476 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14477
14478fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14479 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14480 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14481 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14482 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14483
14484fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14485 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14486 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14487 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14488 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14489
14490fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14491 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14492 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14493 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14494 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14495
14496fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14497 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14498 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14499 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14500 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14501
14502fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14503 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14504 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14505 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14506 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14507
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014508fe_defbe : string
14509 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14510 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014512fe_id : integer
14513 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014514 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014515 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14516
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014517fe_name : string
14518 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14519 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14520 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14521
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014522sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014523sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14524sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14525sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014526 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14527 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14528 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14529
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014530sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014531sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14532sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14533sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014534 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14535 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14536 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14537
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014538sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014539sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14540sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14541sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014542 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14543 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014544 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14545 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14546 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014547
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014548 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014549 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14550 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014551 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14552 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14553 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014554 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14555 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14556
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014557sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14558sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14559sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14560sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14561 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14562 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14563 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14564 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14565 when a first ACL was verified.
14566
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014567sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014568sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14569sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14570sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014571 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014572 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14573
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014574sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014575sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14576sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14577sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014578 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14579 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14580 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14581
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014582sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014583sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14584sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14585sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014586 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14587 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14588 See also src_conn_rate.
14589
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014590sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014591sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14592sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14593sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014594 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014595 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014596
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014597sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14598sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14599sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14600sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14601 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14602 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14603
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014604sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14605sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14606sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14607sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14608 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14609 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14610
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014611sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014612sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14613sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14614sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014615 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14616 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14617 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014618 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14619 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14620 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014621
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014622sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14623sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14624sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14625sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14626 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14627 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14628 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14629 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14630 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14631 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14632
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014633sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014634sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14635sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14636sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014637 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014638 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14639 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14640
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014641sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014642sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14643sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14644sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014645 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14646 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14647 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14648 src_http_err_rate.
14649
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014650sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014651sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14652sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14653sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014654 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014655 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14656 src_http_req_cnt.
14657
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014658sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014659sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14660sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14661sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014662 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14663 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14664 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14665 src_http_req_rate.
14666
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014667sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014668sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14669sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14670sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014671 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014672 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14673 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14674 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14675 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014676
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014677 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014678 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14679 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014680 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14681
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014682sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14683sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14684sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14685sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14686 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14687 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14688 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14689 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14690 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14691
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014692sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014693sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14694sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14695sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014696 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14697 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14698 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014699
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014700sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014701sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14702sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14703sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014704 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14705 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14706 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014707
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014708sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014709sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14710sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14711sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014712 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014713 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14714 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14715 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014716 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014717 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14718
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014719sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014720sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14721sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14722sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014723 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14724 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14725 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14726 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14727 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014728 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014729
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014730sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014731sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14732sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14733sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014734 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14735 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14736 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14737
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014738sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014739sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14740sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14741sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014742 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14743 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014744 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014745 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14746 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014747 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14748 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14749 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014751so_id : integer
14752 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14753 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14754 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014756src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014757 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014758 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14759 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14760 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014761 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14762 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14763 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
14764 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014765
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014766 Example:
14767 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14768 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014770src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14771 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14772 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14773 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014774 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014776src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14777 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14778 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014779 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014780 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14783 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14784 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14785 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14786 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14787 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14788 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014789
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014790 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014791 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14792 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14793 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14794 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014795 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014796 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14797 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14798
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014799src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14800 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14801 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14802 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14803 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14804 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14805 was verified.
14806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014808 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014809 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014810 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014811 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014814 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14816 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014817 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14820 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14821 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14822 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014823 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014826 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014828 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014829 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014830
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014831src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14832 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14833 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14834 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14835 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14836
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014837src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14838 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14839 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14840 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14841 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014843src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014844 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014845 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014846 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14847 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014848 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14849 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14850 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014851
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014852src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14853 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14854 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14855 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14856 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14857 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14858 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14859 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014861src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014862 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014863 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014864 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014865 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14869 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14870 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14871 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14872 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014873 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014875src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014876 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14878 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014879 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014881src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14882 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14883 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14884 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014885 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014886 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14889 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14890 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14891 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014892 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14894 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014895
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014896 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014897 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014898 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014899 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014900
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014901src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14902 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14903 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14904 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14905 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14906 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14907 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14908
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014909src_is_local : boolean
14910 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14911 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14912 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14913 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014914 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014915 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14916 once per connection.
14917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014919 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14920 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14921 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14922 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14923 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014925src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014926 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14927 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14928 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14929 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14930 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932src_port : integer
14933 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14934 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14935 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14936 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014939 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014940 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14941 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14942 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014943 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014945src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14946 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14947 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14948 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14949 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014950 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014952src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14953 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14954 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14955 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14956 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14957 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14958 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14959 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14960 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014961
14962 Example :
14963 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14964 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14965 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14966 listen ssh
14967 bind :22
14968 mode tcp
14969 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014970 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014971 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014972 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014974srv_id : integer
14975 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14976 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14977 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014978
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200149797.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014980----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014982The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14983closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14984when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14985usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014986future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014987
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001498851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14989 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14990 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14991 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14992 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14993 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14994
14995 Example :
14996 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14997 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14998 # the request.
14999 frontend http-in
15000 bind *:8081
15001 default_backend servers
15002 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15003 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15004
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015005ssl_bc : boolean
15006 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15007 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15008 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15009
15010ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15011 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15012 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15013
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015014ssl_bc_alpn : string
15015 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15016 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15017 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15018 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15019 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15020 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15021 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15022 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15023 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15024
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015025ssl_bc_cipher : string
15026 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15027 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15028
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015029ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15030 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15031 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15032 session or a TLS ticket.
15033
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015034ssl_bc_npn : string
15035 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15036 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15037 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15038 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15039 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15040 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15041 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15042 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15043
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015044ssl_bc_protocol : string
15045 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15046 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15047
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015048ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015049 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015050 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15051 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015052
15053ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15054 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15055 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15056 if session was reused or not.
15057
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015058ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15059 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15060 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15061 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15062 BoringSSL.
15063
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015064ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15065 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15066 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15069 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15070 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15071 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15072 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15073 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015075ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15076 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15077 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15078 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15079 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015080
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015081ssl_c_der : binary
15082 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15083 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15084 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086ssl_c_err : integer
15087 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15088 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15089 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15090 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15091 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015093ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15094 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15095 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15096 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15097 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15098 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15099 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15100 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15101 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015103ssl_c_key_alg : string
15104 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15105 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15106 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015108ssl_c_notafter : string
15109 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15110 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15111 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015113ssl_c_notbefore : string
15114 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15115 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15116 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15119 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15120 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15121 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15122 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15123 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15124 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15125 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15126 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128ssl_c_serial : binary
15129 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15130 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15131 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015133ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15134 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15135 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15136 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015137 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15138 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15139
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015140 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015141 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015143ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15144 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15145 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15146 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015148ssl_c_used : boolean
15149 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15150 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015152ssl_c_verify : integer
15153 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15154 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15155 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15156 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015158ssl_c_version : integer
15159 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15160 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015161
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015162ssl_f_der : binary
15163 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15164 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15165 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015167ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15168 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15169 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15170 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15171 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015172 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15174 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15175 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015177ssl_f_key_alg : string
15178 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15179 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15180 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182ssl_f_notafter : string
15183 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15184 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15185 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187ssl_f_notbefore : string
15188 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15189 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15190 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015192ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15193 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15194 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15195 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15196 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15197 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15198 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15199 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15200 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202ssl_f_serial : binary
15203 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15204 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15205 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015206
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015207ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15208 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15209 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15210 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015212ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15213 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15214 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15215 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015217ssl_f_version : integer
15218 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15219 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15220
15221ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015222 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15223 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15224 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015226 Example :
15227 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15228 listen http-https
15229 bind :80
15230 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15231 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15232
15233ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15234 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15235 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15236
15237ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015238 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015239 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15240 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15241 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15242 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15243 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15244 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15245 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15246 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248ssl_fc_cipher : string
15249 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15250 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015251
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015252ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15253 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15254 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015255 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015256
15257ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15258 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15259 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015260 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015261
15262ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15263 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15264 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15265 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015266 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015267 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015268
15269ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15270 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15271 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015272 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015274ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015275 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15276 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015277 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15278 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15279 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15280 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015281
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015282ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15283 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15284 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15285 wait until the handshake happened.
15286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015287ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15288 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015289 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15290 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15291 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15292 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015293
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015294ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015295 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015296 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15297 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015299ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015300 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015301 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15302 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15303 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15304 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15305 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15306 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15307 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309ssl_fc_protocol : string
15310 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15311 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015312
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015313ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015314 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015315 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15316 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015318ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15319 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15320 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15321 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15322 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015323
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015324ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15325 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15326 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15327 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15328 BoringSSL.
15329
15330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015331ssl_fc_sni : string
15332 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15333 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15334 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15335 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15336 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15337
15338 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15339 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15340 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015341 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15342 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015344 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015345 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15346 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015348ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15349 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15350 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015351
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015352
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153537.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015354------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015356Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15357sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15358only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15359For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15360be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15361can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15362sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15363for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15364content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015367 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15369 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015371payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15372 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015373 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015374 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015375
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015376req.hdrs : string
15377 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15378 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15379 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15380 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15381
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015382req.hdrs_bin : binary
15383 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15384 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15385 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15386 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15387 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15388 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15389
15390 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15391
15392 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15393 str: <int:length><bytes>
15394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015395req.len : integer
15396req_len : integer (deprecated)
15397 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15398 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15399 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15400 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15401 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15402 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15403 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15404 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015406req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15407 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015408 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15409 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15410 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15411 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015413 ACL alternatives :
15414 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015416req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15417 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15418 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15419 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15420 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015422 ACL alternatives :
15423 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015427req.proto_http : boolean
15428req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15429 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15430 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15431 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15432 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15433 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15434 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15435 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437 Example:
15438 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15439 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15440 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015441 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15444rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15445 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15446 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15447 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15448 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15449 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15450 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15451 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015453 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15454 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15455 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15456 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15457 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15458 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460 ACL derivatives :
15461 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463 Example :
15464 listen tse-farm
15465 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15466 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15467 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15468 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15469 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15470 persist rdp-cookie
15471 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15472 # This is only useful makes sense if
15473 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15474 stick-table type string size 204800
15475 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15476 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15477 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15480 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15483rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15484 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15485 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15486 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15487 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489 ACL derivatives :
15490 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015491
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015492req.ssl_alpn : string
15493 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15494 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15495 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15496 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15497 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15498 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015499 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015500
15501 Examples :
15502 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15503 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15504 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015505 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015506 default_backend bk_default
15507
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015508req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15509 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15510 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015511 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15512 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15513 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15514 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15515 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15518req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15519 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15520 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15521 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15522 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15523 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15524 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15525 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527req.ssl_sni : string
15528req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15529 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15530 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15531 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15532 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15533 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15534 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15535 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15536 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15537 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15538 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15539 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15540 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542 ACL derivatives :
15543 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545 Examples :
15546 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15547 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15548 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15549 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15550 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015551
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015552req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15553 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15554 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15555 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15556 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15557 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15558 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15559 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15560 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15561 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563req.ssl_ver : integer
15564req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15565 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15566 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15567 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15568 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15569 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15570 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15571 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015572 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575 ACL derivatives :
15576 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015577
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015578res.len : integer
15579 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15580 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15581 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15582 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15583 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15584 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15585 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15586 content inspection.
15587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15589 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015590 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15591 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15592 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15593 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15596 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15597 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15598 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15599 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015602
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015603res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15604rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15605 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15606 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15607 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15608 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15609 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15610 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15611 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613wait_end : boolean
15614 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15615 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015616 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015617 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15618 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015619 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15621 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623 Examples :
15624 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15625 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15626 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15629 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15630 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15631 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15632 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15633 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15634 tcp-request content reject
15635
15636
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156377.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015638--------------------------------------
15639
15640It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15641This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15642data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15643its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15644HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15645content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15646to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15647more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15648response are indexed.
15649
15650base : string
15651 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15652 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15653 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15654 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15655 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15656 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15657 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15658 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15659
15660 ACL derivatives :
15661 base : exact string match
15662 base_beg : prefix match
15663 base_dir : subdir match
15664 base_dom : domain match
15665 base_end : suffix match
15666 base_len : length match
15667 base_reg : regex match
15668 base_sub : substring match
15669
15670base32 : integer
15671 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15672 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15673 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015674 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15675 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15676 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677
15678base32+src : binary
15679 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15680 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15681 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15682 per-URL counters.
15683
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015684capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15685 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15686 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15687 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15688
15689capture.req.method : string
15690 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15691 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15692 because it's allocated.
15693
15694capture.req.uri : string
15695 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15696 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15697 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15698 allocated.
15699
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015700capture.req.ver : string
15701 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15702 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15703 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15704
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015705capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15706 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15707 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15708 The first entry is an index of 0.
15709 See also: "capture response header"
15710
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015711capture.res.ver : string
15712 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15713 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15714 persistent flag.
15715
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015716req.body : binary
15717 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15718 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15719 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15720 the first chunk is analyzed.
15721
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015722req.body_param([<name>) : string
15723 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15724 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15725 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15726 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15727 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15728 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15729 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15730 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15731 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15732 given.
15733
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015734req.body_len : integer
15735 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15736 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15737 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15738 "option http-buffer-request".
15739
15740req.body_size : integer
15741 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15742 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15743 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15744 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15745 "option http-buffer-request".
15746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747req.cook([<name>]) : string
15748cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15749 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15750 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15751 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15752 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15753 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15754 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15755 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15756 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15757
15758 ACL derivatives :
15759 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15760 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15761 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15762 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15763 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15764 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15765 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15766 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15769cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15770 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15771 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015773req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15774cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15775 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15776 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15777 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15778 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15781 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15782 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15783 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15784 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015785 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15787 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15788 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15789 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015791hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15792 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15793 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15794 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15795 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015796 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15799 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15800 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15801 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15802 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15803 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15804 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15805 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15806 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15809 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15810 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15811 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15812 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15815 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15816 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15817 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15818 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15819 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15820 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15821 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15822 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015823 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015824 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015825 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015827 ACL derivatives :
15828 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15829 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15830 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15831 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15832 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15833 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15834 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15835 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15836
15837req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15838hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15839 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15840 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15841 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15842 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15843 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15844 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15845 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15846 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15847 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15848
15849req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15850hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15851 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15852 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15853 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15854 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15855 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015856 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015857 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15858 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15859
15860req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15861hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15862 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15863 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15864 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15865 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15866 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15867 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15868 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15869
15870http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15871 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15872 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15873 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15874 basic auth is supported.
15875
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015876http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15877 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15878 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15879 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15880 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15882 basic auth is supported.
15883
15884 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015885 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15886 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15887 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15888 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015889
15890http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015891 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15892 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15894 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896method : integer + string
15897 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15898 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15899 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15900 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15901 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15902 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15903 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905 ACL derivatives :
15906 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908 Example :
15909 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15910 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15911 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913path : string
15914 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15915 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15916 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15917 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15918 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015919 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922 ACL derivatives :
15923 path : exact string match
15924 path_beg : prefix match
15925 path_dir : subdir match
15926 path_dom : domain match
15927 path_end : suffix match
15928 path_len : length match
15929 path_reg : regex match
15930 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015931
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015932query : string
15933 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15934 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15935 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15936 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015937 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015938 which stops before the question mark.
15939
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015940req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15941 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15942 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15943 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15944 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946req.ver : string
15947req_ver : string (deprecated)
15948 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15949 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15950 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952 ACL derivatives :
15953 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015955res.comp : boolean
15956 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15957 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15958 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960res.comp_algo : string
15961 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15962 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15963 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965res.cook([<name>]) : string
15966scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15967 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15968 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15969 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015971 ACL derivatives :
15972 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15975scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15976 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15977 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15978 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015980res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15981scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15982 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15983 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15984 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015986res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15987 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15988 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15989 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15990 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15991 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15992 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15993 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15994 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15995 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015997res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15998 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15999 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16000 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16001 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16002 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016004res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16005shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16006 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16007 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16008 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16009 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16010 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16011 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16012 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16013 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016015 ACL derivatives :
16016 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16017 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16018 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16019 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16020 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16021 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16022 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16023 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16024
16025res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16026shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16027 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16028 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16029 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16030 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16031 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016033res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16034shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16035 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16036 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16037 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16038 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16039 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16040 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016041
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016042res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16043 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16044 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16045 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16046 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016048res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16049shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16050 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16051 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16052 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16053 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16054 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16055 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057res.ver : string
16058resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16059 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16060 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062 ACL derivatives :
16063 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016065set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16066 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16067 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016068 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16072 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074status : integer
16075 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16076 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16077 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016078
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016079unique-id : string
16080 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16081 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16082 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16083 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16084 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16085 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087url : string
16088 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16089 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16090 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16091 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16092 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16093 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16094 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096 ACL derivatives :
16097 url : exact string match
16098 url_beg : prefix match
16099 url_dir : subdir match
16100 url_dom : domain match
16101 url_end : suffix match
16102 url_len : length match
16103 url_reg : regex match
16104 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106url_ip : ip
16107 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16108 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16109 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16110 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16111 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16112 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16113 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115url_port : integer
16116 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16117 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16118 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16119 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016120
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016121urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16122url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016123 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16124 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016125 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16126 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16127 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16128 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16130 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016131 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16132 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016134 ACL derivatives :
16135 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16136 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16137 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16138 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16139 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16140 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16141 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16142 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016143
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145 Example :
16146 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16147 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16148 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16149 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016150
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016151urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016152 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16153 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16154 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016155
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016156url32 : integer
16157 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16158 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16159 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16160 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16161 is an unsigned integer.
16162
16163url32+src : binary
16164 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16165 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16166 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16167
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200161697.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016170---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016172Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16173every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016174order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016176ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16177---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016178FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016179HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016180HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16181HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016182HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16183HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16184HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16185HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16186LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016187METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016188METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016189METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16190METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16191METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16192METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016193METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016194METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016195RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016196REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016197TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016198WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16199---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016200
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162028. Logging
16203----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016204
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016205One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16206provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16207very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16208provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16209state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016210to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016211headers.
16212
16213In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16214about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16215send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16216
16217 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16218 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16219 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16220 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16221 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016222 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016223 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016224
16225The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16226allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16227as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16228while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16229real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16230delay.
16231
16232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162338.1. Log levels
16234---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016235
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016236TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016237source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016238HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16239in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16240track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16241syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16242about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016243
16244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162458.2. Log formats
16246----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016247
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016248HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016249and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16250slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16251options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016252
16253 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16254 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16255 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16256 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16257 extents.
16258
16259 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16260 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16261 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16262 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16263 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16264
16265 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16266 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16267 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16268 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16269 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16270
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016271 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16272 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16273 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16274 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16275
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016276 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16277
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016278Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16279specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16280field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16281servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16282always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16283identifier.
16284
16285Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16286 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16287 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16288 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16289 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16290
16291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162928.2.1. Default log format
16293-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016294
16295This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16296as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16297format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16298
16299 Example :
16300 listen www
16301 mode http
16302 log global
16303 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16304
16305 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16306 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16307 (www/HTTP)
16308
16309 Field Format Extract from the example above
16310 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16311 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16312 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16313 4 'to' to
16314 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16315 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16316
16317Detailed fields description :
16318 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16319 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16320 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16321 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16322 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16323 and processed the connection.
16324 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16325
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016326In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16327"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16328connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16329
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016330It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16331will eventually disappear.
16332
16333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163348.2.2. TCP log format
16335---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016336
16337The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16338is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16339information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16340counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16341emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16342environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16343the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16344sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016345specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16346not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16347fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16348marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016349
16350 Example :
16351 frontend fnt
16352 mode tcp
16353 option tcplog
16354 log global
16355 default_backend bck
16356
16357 backend bck
16358 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16359
16360 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16361 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16362 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16363
16364 Field Format Extract from the example above
16365 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16366 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16367 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16368 4 frontend_name fnt
16369 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16370 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16371 7 bytes_read* 212
16372 8 termination_state --
16373 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16374 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16375
16376Detailed fields description :
16377 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016378 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16379 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16380 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016381 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016382 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016383 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016384
16385 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016386 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16387 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16388 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016389
16390 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16391 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16392 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016393 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16394 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16395 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16396 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016397
16398 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16399 and processed the connection.
16400
16401 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16402 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16403 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16404 applications.
16405
16406 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16407 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16408 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16409 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16410 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16411
16412 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16413 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16414 See "Timers" below for more details.
16415
16416 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16417 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16418 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16419 "Timers" below for more details.
16420
16421 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016422 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016423 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16424 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16425 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16426 details.
16427
16428 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16429 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16430 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16431 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16432 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16433
16434 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16435 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16436 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16437 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16438 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16439 for more details.
16440
16441 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016442 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016443 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16444 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16445 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016446 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016447
16448 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16449 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16450 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16451 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16452 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16453 caused by a denial of service attack.
16454
16455 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16456 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16457 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16458 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16459 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16460 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16461 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16462 denial of service attack.
16463
16464 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16465 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16466 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16467 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16468 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16469 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16470 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16471 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16472 be processed than on other servers.
16473
16474 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16475 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16476 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16477 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16478 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16479 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16480 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16481 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16482 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16483 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16484 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16485 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16486 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16487
16488 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16489 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16490 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16491 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16492 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16493 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016494 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016495 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16496
16497 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16498 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16499 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16500 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16501 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16502 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016503 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016504 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16505 occurs.
16506
16507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165088.2.3. HTTP log format
16509----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016510
16511The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16512is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16513the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16514are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16515emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16516generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16517"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16518which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016519frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16520is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016521
16522Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16523slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16524with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16525
16526 Example :
16527 frontend http-in
16528 mode http
16529 option httplog
16530 log global
16531 default_backend bck
16532
16533 backend static
16534 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16535
16536 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16537 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16538 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016539 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016540
16541 Field Format Extract from the example above
16542 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16543 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016544 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016545 4 frontend_name http-in
16546 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016547 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016548 7 status_code 200
16549 8 bytes_read* 2750
16550 9 captured_request_cookie -
16551 10 captured_response_cookie -
16552 11 termination_state ----
16553 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16554 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16555 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16556 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16557 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016558
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016559Detailed fields description :
16560 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016561 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16562 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16563 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016564 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016565 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016566 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016567
16568 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016569 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16570 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16571 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016572
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016573 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16574 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016575
16576 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16577 and processed the connection.
16578
16579 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16580 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16581 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16582
16583 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16584 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16585 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16586 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16587 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16588 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16589
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016590 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16591 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16592 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16593 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16594 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16595 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016596 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16597 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016598
16599 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16600 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016601 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016602
16603 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16604 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016605 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16606 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016607
16608 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16609 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16610 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16611 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16612 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016613 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16614 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016615
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016616 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16617 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16618 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16619 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16620 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16621 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16622 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016623 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016624
16625 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16626 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16627 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16628
16629 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16630 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16631 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16632 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16633 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16634 overflowing.
16635
16636 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16637 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16638 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16639 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16640 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16641 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16642 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16643 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16644
16645 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16646 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16647 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16648 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16649 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16650 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16651 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16652 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16653
16654 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16655 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16656 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16657 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16658 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16659 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16660 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16661
16662 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016663 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016664 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16665 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16666 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016667 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016668 system.
16669
16670 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16671 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16672 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16673 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16674 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16675 caused by a denial of service attack.
16676
16677 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16678 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16679 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16680 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16681 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16682 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16683 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16684 denial of service attack.
16685
16686 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16687 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16688 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16689 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16690 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16691 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16692 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16693 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16694 processed than on other servers.
16695
16696 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16697 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16698 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16699 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16700 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16701 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16702 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16703 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16704 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16705 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16706 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16707 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16708 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16709
16710 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16711 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16712 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16713 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16714 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16715 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016716 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016717 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16718
16719 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16720 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16721 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16722 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16723 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16724 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016725 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016726 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16727 occurs.
16728
16729 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16730 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16731 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16732 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16733 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16734 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16735 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16736 cookies" below for more details.
16737
16738 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16739 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16740 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16741 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16742 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16743 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16744 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16745 and cookies" below for more details.
16746
16747 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16748 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16749 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16750 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16751 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16752 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16753 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16754 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16755
16756
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200167578.2.4. Custom log format
16758------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016759
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016760The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016761mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016762
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016763HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016764Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16765separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16766prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16767
16768Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16769variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016770("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016771
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016772If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016773as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016774less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16775the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16776
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016777Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016778In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016779in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016780
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016781Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16782'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16783https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16784such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16785
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016786Flags are :
16787 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016788 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016789 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16790 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016791
16792 Example:
16793
16794 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16795 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16796
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016797 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16798
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016799At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16800
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016801 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16802 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016803
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016804the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016805
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016806 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16807 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16808 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016809
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016810and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16811
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016812 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16813 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016814
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016815Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16816
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016817 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016818 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016819 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16820 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16821 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016822 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16823 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16824 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016825 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016826 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16827 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016828 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016829 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16830 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016831 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016832 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016833 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016834 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016835 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016836 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016837 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016838 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16839 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16840 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16841 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16842 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016843 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016844 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16845 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016846 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016847 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16848 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016849 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16850 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16851 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016852 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016853 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16854 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016855 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016856 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16857 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16858 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016859 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016860 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016861 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16862 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16863 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16864 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016865 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016866 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016867 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016868 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016869 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016870 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016871 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16872 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16873 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016874 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016875 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16876 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016877 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016878 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16879 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016880 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016881 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016882 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016883 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016884
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016885 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016886
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016887
168888.2.5. Error log format
16889-----------------------
16890
16891When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16892protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16893By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16894"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016895will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016896logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16897
16898The format looks like this :
16899
16900 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16901 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16902 Connection error during SSL handshake
16903
16904 Field Format Extract from the example above
16905 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16906 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16907 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16908 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16909 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16910
16911These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16912failures.
16913
16914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169158.3. Advanced logging options
16916-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016917
16918Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16919just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16920options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16921for more information about their usage.
16922
16923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169248.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16925------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016926
16927It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16928haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16929commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16930monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16931ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16932
16933 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16934 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16935 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16936 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16937
16938 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16939 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16940 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016941 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016942 such as other load-balancers.
16943
16944 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16945 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16946 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16947
16948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169498.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16950----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016951
16952The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16953what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16954or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016955"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016956just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16957log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16958after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16959is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16960with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16961with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16962
16963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169648.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16965------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016966
16967Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16968for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16969"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16970retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16971raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16972a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16973file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16974you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16975"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16976
16977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169788.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16979--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016980
16981Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16982multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16983them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16984"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16985logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16986error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16987and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16988too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16989useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16990alternative.
16991
16992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169938.4. Timing events
16994------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016995
16996Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16997reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16998the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16999frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017000mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17001addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17002
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017003Timings events in HTTP mode:
17004
17005 first request 2nd request
17006 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17007 t tr t tr ...
17008 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17009 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17010 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17011 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17012 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17013
17014Timings events in TCP mode:
17015
17016 TCP session
17017 |<----------------->|
17018 t t
17019 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17020 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17021 |<------ Tt ------->|
17022
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017023 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017024 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017025 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17026 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17027 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017028 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017029 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17030 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17031 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17032 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017033
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017034 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17035 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17036 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017037 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17038 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17039 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17040 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17041 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17042 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017043
17044 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17045 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17046 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17047 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17048 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17049 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17050 request typed by hand during a test.
17051
17052 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17053 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017054 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017055 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17056 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17057 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17058 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017059
17060 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17061 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17062 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17063 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17064 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17065
17066 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17067 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17068 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17069 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17070 connection never established.
17071
17072 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17073 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17074 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17075 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17076 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17077 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17078 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17079 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17080 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17081 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17082 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17083
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017084 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17085 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17086 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17087 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17088 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17089 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17090
17091 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17092
17093 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17094 "Ta" can never be negative.
17095
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017096 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17097 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017098 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17099 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017100 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017101
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017102 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017103
17104 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017105 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17106 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017107
17108These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17109protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17110that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017111due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17112"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17113that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017114
17115Most common cases :
17116
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017117 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17118 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17119 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17120 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17121 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17122 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17123 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17124 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17125 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17126 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17127 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017128 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017129
17130 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17131 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17132 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17133 of ms on remote networks.
17134
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017135 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17136 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17137 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017138
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017139 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17140 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17141 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17142 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17143 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17144 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17145 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17146 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17147 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017148
17149Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17150
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017151 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017152 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017153 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017154
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017155 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017156 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17157 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17158
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017159 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017160 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17161 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17162 flags.
17163
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017164 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17165 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017166 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17167 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17168 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17169 the client connection was maintained open.
17170
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017171 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017172 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017173 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017174 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17175
17176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171778.5. Session state at disconnection
17178-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017179
17180TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17181"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
171822-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17183each of which has a special meaning :
17184
17185 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17186 session to terminate :
17187
17188 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17189
17190 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17191 server explicitly refused it.
17192
17193 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17194 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17195 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17196 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017197 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017198
17199 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17200 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017201
17202 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17203 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17204 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17205 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17206 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17207
17208 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17209 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17210 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17211 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17212 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17213
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017214 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17215 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17216
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017217 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17218 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17219 backup connections when going up.
17220
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017221 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017223 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17224 send or receive data.
17225
17226 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17227 send or receive data.
17228
17229 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17230 with nothing left in the buffers.
17231
17232 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17233
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017234 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017235 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17236
17237 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17238 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17239 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17240 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17241 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17242
17243 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17244 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17245
17246 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17247 server (HTTP only).
17248
17249 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17250
17251 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17252 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17253 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17254
17255 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17256 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17257 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17258
17259 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17260
17261 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17262 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17263
17264 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17265 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17266 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17267
17268 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17269 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017270 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17271 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017272
17273 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17274 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17275 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17276 another server.
17277
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017278 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017279 server.
17280
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017281 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17282 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17283 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17284 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17285
17286 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17287 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17288 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17289 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17290
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017291 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17292 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17293 "use-server" rule).
17294
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17296
17297 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17298 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17299
17300 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17301
17302 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17303 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17304 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17305
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017306 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17307 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017308 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017309 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17310 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17311
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017312 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17313
17314 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17315 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17316
17317 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17318
17319 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17320
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017321The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17322was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017323helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17324starvation, attacks, etc...
17325
17326The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17327alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17328easier finding and understanding.
17329
17330 Flags Reason
17331
17332 -- Normal termination.
17333
17334 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17335 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17336 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17337 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17338
17339 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17340 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17341 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17342 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17343 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17344 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017345
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017346 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17347 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017348 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017349
17350 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17351 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17352 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17353
17354 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17355 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17356 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17357 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17358 the server takes too long to respond.
17359
17360 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17361 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17362 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17363 long a time to respond.
17364
17365 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17366 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17367 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17368 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017369 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17370 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017371
17372 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17373 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17374 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17375 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17376 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017377 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017378 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17379 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17380 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17381 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17382 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17383 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17384 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17385 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017386 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017387 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17388 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17389 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017390
17391 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17392 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017393 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17394 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17395 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17396 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017397
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017398 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17399 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17400
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017401 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017402 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17403 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017404 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017405 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17406 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17407
17408 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17409 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17410 503 or 504 here.
17411
17412 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17413 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17414 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17415 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17416 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17417
17418 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17419 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017420 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017421 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17422 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17423
17424 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17425 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17426 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17427 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17428 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17429 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17430 between haproxy and the server.
17431
17432 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17433 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17434 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17435 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17436 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17437 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17438 solution is to fix the application.
17439
17440 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17441 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17442 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17443 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17444 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17445 external attacks.
17446
17447 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17448 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017449 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017450 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17451 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17452
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017453 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17454 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17455 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017456 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017457 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017458
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017459 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17460 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17461 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17462 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017463 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17464 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17465 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17466 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17467 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017468
17469 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17470 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17471 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17472 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17473
17474 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17475 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17476 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17477 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17478
17479 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17480 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17481 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17482 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17483
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017484The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17485persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17486important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17487re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17488
17489 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17490
17491 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17492 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17493 set on a GET request.
17494
17495 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17496 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017497 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017498 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17499
17500 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17501 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17502 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17503
17504 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17505 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17506 already got a cookie.
17507
17508 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17509 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17510 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17511 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17512 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17513
17514 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17515 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17516 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17517
17518 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17519 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17520 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17521
17522 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17523 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17524
17525 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17526 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17527 then advertised in the response.
17528
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175308.6. Non-printable characters
17531-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017532
17533In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17534consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17535converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17536prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17537being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17538escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17539is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17540'}' when logging headers.
17541
17542Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17543issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17544containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17545
17546Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17547the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17548performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17549
17550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175518.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17552---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017553
17554Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17555achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017556section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017557cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17558the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17559the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017560locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017561not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17562user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17563a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17564wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17565
17566 Examples :
17567 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17568 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17569
17570 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17571 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17572
17573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175748.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17575---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017576
17577Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17578proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17579the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17580server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17581
17582Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17583response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017584section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017585
17586It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017587time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17588appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017589are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17590and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17591follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17592request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17593in the logs.
17594
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017595As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17596frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17597an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17598
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017599 Example :
17600 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17601 listen proxy-out
17602 mode http
17603 option httplog
17604 option logasap
17605 log global
17606 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17607
17608 # log the name of the virtual server
17609 capture request header Host len 20
17610
17611 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17612 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17613
17614 # log the beginning of the referrer
17615 capture request header Referer len 20
17616
17617 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17618 capture response header Server len 20
17619
17620 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17621 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17622
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017623 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017624 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17625
17626 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17627 capture response header Via len 20
17628
17629 # log the URL location during a redirection
17630 capture response header Location len 20
17631
17632 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17633 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17634 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17635 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17636 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17637
17638 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17639 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17640 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17641 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017642 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017643
17644 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17645 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17646 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17647 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17648 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017649 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017650
17651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176528.9. Examples of logs
17653---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017654
17655These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17656them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17657reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17658
17659 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17660 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17661 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17662
17663 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17664 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17665
17666 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17667 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17668 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17669
17670 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17671 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17672
17673 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17674 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17675 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17676
17677 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017678 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017679 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17680 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17681
17682 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17683 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17684 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17685
17686 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17687 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017688 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017689 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17690 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17691 to return the 502 and not the server.
17692
17693 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017694 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017695
17696 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17697 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17698 Nothing was sent to any server.
17699
17700 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17701 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17702
17703 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17704 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017705 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017706 send a 408 return code to the client.
17707
17708 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17709 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17710
17711 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17712 5 seconds ("c----").
17713
17714 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17715 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017716 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017717
17718 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017719 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017720 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17721 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17722 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17723 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17724 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017725
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017726
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200177279. Supported filters
17728--------------------
17729
17730Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17731accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17732unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17733
17734See also : "filter"
17735
177369.1. Trace
17737----------
17738
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017739filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017740
17741 Arguments:
17742 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17743 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17744
17745 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17746 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17747 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17748 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17749
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017750 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017751 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17752 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17753 amount of the parsed data.
17754
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017755 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017756
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017757This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17758callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17759information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17760filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17761
17762Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17763tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17764a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17765
17766
177679.2. HTTP compression
17768---------------------
17769
17770filter compression
17771
17772The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17773keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017774when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17775it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17776response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17777line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17778cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17779the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017780
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017781See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017782
17783
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200177849.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17785--------------------------------------------
17786
17787filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17788
17789 Arguments :
17790
17791 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17792 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17793 parsed.
17794
17795 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17796 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17797 part must be placed in its own scope.
17798
17799The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17800external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017801streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017802exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17803also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17804
17805SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17806the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17807
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017808For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017809"doc/SPOE.txt".
17810
17811Important note:
17812 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17813 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17814
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100178159.4. Cache
17816----------
17817
17818filter cache <name>
17819
17820 Arguments :
17821
17822 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17823
17824The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17825"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17826cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017827other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17828the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17829mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17830filter other than the compression is used for the same
17831listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17832order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017833
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017834See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017835
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001783610. Cache
17837---------
17838
17839HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17840(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17841RAM.
17842
17843The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017844this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017845
17846If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17847independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17848when we try to allocate a new one.
17849
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017850The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017851
17852It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17853"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17854for more details.
17855
17856When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17857replaced by "<CACHE>".
17858
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001785910.1. Limitation
17860----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017861
17862The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17863
17864- If the response is not a 200
17865- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017866- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017867- If the response is not cacheable
17868
17869- If the request is not a GET
17870- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017871- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017872
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017873Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
17874filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
17875can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
17876example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
17877"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017878
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001787910.2. Setup
17880-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017881
17882To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17883the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17884
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001788510.2.1. Cache section
17886---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017887
17888cache <name>
17889 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17890 size of cache is mandatory.
17891
17892total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017893 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017894 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017895
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017896max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017897 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17898 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17899 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017900
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017901max-age <seconds>
17902 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17903 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17904 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17905 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17906 default.
17907
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001790810.2.2. Proxy section
17909---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017910
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020017911http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017912 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17913 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17914 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17915 after this one.
17916
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020017917http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017918 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17919 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17920 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17921 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17922
17923
17924Example:
17925
17926 backend bck1
17927 mode http
17928
17929 http-request cache-use foobar
17930 http-response cache-store foobar
17931 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17932
17933 cache foobar
17934 total-max-size 4
17935 max-age 240
17936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017937/*
17938 * Local variables:
17939 * fill-column: 79
17940 * End:
17941 */